blob: 8b582da8fa3bef55a867ee0ac35a55e896811076 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattnerdd1a86d2004-05-04 15:19:33 +000015// %Y = add int %X, 1
16// %Z = add int %Y, 1
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattnerdd1a86d2004-05-04 15:19:33 +000018// %Z = add int %X, 2
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner216c7b82003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattnerb4cfa7f2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner024f4ab2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000043#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
44#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000046#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000047#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000048#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000049#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +000050#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000051#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattner3d27be12006-08-27 12:54:02 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +000053#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Reid Spencer7c16caa2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +000056#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencer3f4e6e82007-02-04 00:40:42 +000057#include <set>
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000058using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000059using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +000060
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000061STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
62STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
63STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
64STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
65STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnerbf3a0992002-10-01 22:38:41 +000066
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000067namespace {
Chris Lattner4a4c7fe2006-06-28 22:08:15 +000068 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
69 : public FunctionPass,
70 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000071 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
72 std::vector<Instruction*> WorkList;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000073 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000074
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +000075 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
76 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
77 /// now.
78 ///
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +000079 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +000080 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000081 UI != UE; ++UI)
82 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
83 }
84
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +000085 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
86 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
87 ///
88 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
89 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
90 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
91 WorkList.push_back(Op);
92 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000093
94 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
95 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
96 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
97 ///
98 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
99 ///
100 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
101 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
102
103 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
104 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
105 WorkList.push_back(Op);
106 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
107 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
108 }
109
110 return R;
111 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000112
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +0000113 // removeFromWorkList - remove all instances of I from the worklist.
114 void removeFromWorkList(Instruction *I);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000115 public:
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000118 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000119 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000120 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattner820d9712002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000121 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000122 }
123
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000124 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
125
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000126 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
127 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
128 // Return Value:
129 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000130 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000131 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000132 //
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000133 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
134 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
135 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000136 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
137 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
138 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
139 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
140 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000141 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
142 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
143 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
144 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
145 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000146 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
147 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
148 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000149 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
150 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
151 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
152 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000153 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
154 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
155 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000156
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000157 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
158 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000159 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000160 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000161 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
162 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
163 Instruction *visitTrunc(CastInst &CI);
164 Instruction *visitZExt(CastInst &CI);
165 Instruction *visitSExt(CastInst &CI);
166 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
167 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
168 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
169 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
170 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
171 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
172 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
173 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
174 Instruction *visitBitCast(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000175 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
176 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000177 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000178 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
179 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000180 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
181 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000182 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000183 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000184 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000185 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000186 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000187 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000188 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000189 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000190 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000191
192 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000193 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000194
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000195 private:
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000196 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000197 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
198
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000199 public:
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000200 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
201 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
202 //
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000203 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattner65217ff2002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000204 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
205 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000206 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
207 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
208 WorkList.push_back(New); // Add to worklist
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000209 return New;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000210 }
211
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000212 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
213 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
214 /// cast.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000215 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
216 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000217 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000218
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000219 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000220 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000221
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000222 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000223 WorkList.push_back(C);
224 return C;
225 }
226
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000227 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
228 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
229 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
230 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
231 // modified.
232 //
233 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000234 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000235 if (&I != V) {
236 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
237 return &I;
238 } else {
239 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
240 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000241 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000242 return &I;
243 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000244 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000245
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000246 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
247 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
248 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
249 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
250 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
251 //
252 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
253 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
254 if (Old != New)
255 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
256 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
257 WorkList.push_back(I);
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000258 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
259 WorkList.push_back(I);
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000260 return true;
261 }
262
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000263 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
264 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
265 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
266 // this function.
267 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
268 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
269 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
270 removeFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner95307542004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000271 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000272 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
273 }
274
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000275 private:
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000276 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
277 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
278 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
279 ///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000280 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
281 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000282 Instruction *InsertBefore);
283
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000284 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
285 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000286 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000287
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000288 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
289 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
290 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
291
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000292 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, uint64_t Mask,
293 uint64_t &KnownZero, uint64_t &KnownOne,
294 unsigned Depth = 0);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000295
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000296 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
297 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
298
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000299 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
300 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
301 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
302 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
303
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000304 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
305 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
306 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
307 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000308 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
309
310
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000311 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
312 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000313
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000314 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000315 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000316 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000317 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +0000318 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000319 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
320
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000321 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000322 };
Chris Lattnerb28b6802002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000323
Chris Lattnerc2d3d312006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000324 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000325}
326
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000327// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000328// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000329static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
330 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
331 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000332 return 3;
333 return 4;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000334 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000335 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
336 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000337}
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000338
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000339// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
340// it.
341static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000342 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000343}
344
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000345// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
346// though a va_arg area...
347static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000348 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
349 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
350 return Type::Int32Ty;
351 } else if (Ty == Type::FloatTy)
352 return Type::DoubleTy;
353 return Ty;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000354}
355
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000356/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
357/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
358static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
359 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000360 return I->getOperand(0);
361 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000362 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000363 return CE->getOperand(0);
364 return 0;
365}
366
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000367/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
368/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
369/// @Determine if it is valid to eliminate a Convert pair
370static Instruction::CastOps
371isEliminableCastPair(
372 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
373 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
374 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
375 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
376) {
377
378 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
379 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000380
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000381 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
382 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
383 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000384
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000385 return Instruction::CastOps(
386 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
387 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000388}
389
390/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
391/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
392/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000393static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
394 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000395 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
396
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000397 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000398 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000399 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000400 return false;
401 return true;
402}
403
404/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
405/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
406/// casts that are known to not do anything...
407///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000408Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
409 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000410 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
411 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
412 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000413 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000414
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000415 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000416}
417
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000418// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
419// operators:
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000420//
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000421// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
422// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
423// binary operators.
424//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000425// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
426// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000427//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000428bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000429 bool Changed = false;
430 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
431 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000432
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000433 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
434 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000435 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
436 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
437 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000438 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
439 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
440 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000441 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
442 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
443 return true;
444 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
445 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
446 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
447 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
448 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
449
450 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000451 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000452 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
453 Op1->getOperand(0),
454 Op1->getName(), &I);
455 WorkList.push_back(New);
456 I.setOperand(0, New);
457 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
458 return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000459 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000460 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000461 return Changed;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000462}
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000463
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000464/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
465/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
466/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
467bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
468 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
469 return false;
470 I.swapOperands();
471 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
472 return true;
473}
474
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000475// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
476// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000477//
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000478static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
479 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000480 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000481
Chris Lattner9ad0d552004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000482 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
483 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
484 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000485 return 0;
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000486}
487
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000488static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
489 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000490 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000491
492 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000493 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +0000494 return ConstantExpr::getNot(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000495 return 0;
496}
497
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000498// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
499// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000500// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
501// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000502//
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000503static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000504 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000505 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000506 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000507 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000508 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000509 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000510 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000511 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
512 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
513 CST = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getShl(One, CST));
514 return I->getOperand(0);
515 }
516 }
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000517 return 0;
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000518}
Chris Lattner31ae8632002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000519
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000520/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
521/// expression, return it.
522static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
523 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
524 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
525 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
526 return cast<User>(V);
527 return false;
528}
529
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000530// AddOne, SubOne - Add or subtract a constant one from an integer constant...
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000531static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
532 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getAdd(C,
533 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1)));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000534}
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000535static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
536 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSub(C,
537 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1)));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000538}
539
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000540/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
541/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
542/// bitsets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
543/// processing.
544static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, uint64_t Mask, uint64_t &KnownZero,
545 uint64_t &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +0000546 // Note, we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
547 // we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +0000548 // it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +0000549 // optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
550 // Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
551 // this won't lose us code quality.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000552 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000553 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000554 KnownOne = CI->getZExtValue() & Mask;
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000555 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
556 return;
557 }
558
559 KnownZero = KnownOne = 0; // Don't know anything.
Chris Lattner92a68652006-02-07 08:05:22 +0000560 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000561 return; // Limit search depth.
562
563 uint64_t KnownZero2, KnownOne2;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000564 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
565 if (!I) return;
566
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000567 Mask &= cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitMask();
Chris Lattnerfb296922006-05-04 17:33:35 +0000568
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000569 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
570 case Instruction::And:
571 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
572 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
573 Mask &= ~KnownZero;
574 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
575 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
576 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
577
578 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
579 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
580 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
581 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
582 return;
583 case Instruction::Or:
584 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
585 Mask &= ~KnownOne;
586 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
587 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
588 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
589
590 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
591 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
592 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
593 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
594 return;
595 case Instruction::Xor: {
596 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
597 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
598 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
599 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
600
601 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
602 uint64_t KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
603 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
604 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
605 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
606 return;
607 }
608 case Instruction::Select:
609 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
610 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
611 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
612 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
613
614 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
615 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
616 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
617 return;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000618 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
619 case Instruction::FPExt:
620 case Instruction::FPToUI:
621 case Instruction::FPToSI:
622 case Instruction::SIToFP:
623 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
624 case Instruction::UIToFP:
625 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
626 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
627 case Instruction::Trunc:
628 // All these have integer operands
629 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
630 return;
631 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000632 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000633 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000634 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000635 return;
636 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000637 break;
638 }
639 case Instruction::ZExt: {
640 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000641 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
642 uint64_t NotIn = ~SrcTy->getBitMask();
643 uint64_t NewBits = cast<IntegerType>(I->getType())->getBitMask() & NotIn;
Chris Lattner62010c42005-10-09 06:36:35 +0000644
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000645 Mask &= SrcTy->getBitMask();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000646 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
647 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
648 // The top bits are known to be zero.
649 KnownZero |= NewBits;
650 return;
651 }
652 case Instruction::SExt: {
653 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000654 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
655 uint64_t NotIn = ~SrcTy->getBitMask();
656 uint64_t NewBits = cast<IntegerType>(I->getType())->getBitMask() & NotIn;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000657
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000658 Mask &= SrcTy->getBitMask();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000659 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
660 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Chris Lattner92a68652006-02-07 08:05:22 +0000661
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000662 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
663 // top bits of the result.
664 uint64_t InSignBit = 1ULL << (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
665 if (KnownZero & InSignBit) { // Input sign bit known zero
666 KnownZero |= NewBits;
667 KnownOne &= ~NewBits;
668 } else if (KnownOne & InSignBit) { // Input sign bit known set
669 KnownOne |= NewBits;
670 KnownZero &= ~NewBits;
671 } else { // Input sign bit unknown
672 KnownZero &= ~NewBits;
673 KnownOne &= ~NewBits;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000674 }
675 return;
676 }
677 case Instruction::Shl:
678 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000679 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
680 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
681 Mask >>= ShiftAmt;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000682 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
683 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000684 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
685 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
686 KnownZero |= (1ULL << ShiftAmt)-1; // low bits known zero.
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000687 return;
688 }
689 break;
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +0000690 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000691 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000692 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000693 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000694 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
695 uint64_t HighBits = (1ULL << ShiftAmt)-1;
696 HighBits <<= I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-ShiftAmt;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000697
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +0000698 // Unsigned shift right.
699 Mask <<= ShiftAmt;
700 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
701 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
702 KnownZero >>= ShiftAmt;
703 KnownOne >>= ShiftAmt;
704 KnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
705 return;
706 }
707 break;
708 case Instruction::AShr:
709 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
710 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
711 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
712 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
713 uint64_t HighBits = (1ULL << ShiftAmt)-1;
714 HighBits <<= I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-ShiftAmt;
715
716 // Signed shift right.
717 Mask <<= ShiftAmt;
718 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
719 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
720 KnownZero >>= ShiftAmt;
721 KnownOne >>= ShiftAmt;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000722
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +0000723 // Handle the sign bits.
724 uint64_t SignBit = 1ULL << (I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
725 SignBit >>= ShiftAmt; // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000726
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +0000727 if (KnownZero & SignBit) { // New bits are known zero.
728 KnownZero |= HighBits;
729 } else if (KnownOne & SignBit) { // New bits are known one.
730 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000731 }
732 return;
Chris Lattner62010c42005-10-09 06:36:35 +0000733 }
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000734 break;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +0000735 }
Chris Lattner92a68652006-02-07 08:05:22 +0000736}
737
738/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
739/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
740/// for bits that V cannot have.
741static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, uint64_t Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000742 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
743 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
744 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
745 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +0000746}
747
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000748/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
749/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
750/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
751/// constant and return true.
752static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
753 uint64_t Demanded) {
754 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
755 if (!OpC) return false;
756
757 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
758 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getZExtValue()) == 0)
759 return false;
760
761 // This is producing any bits that are not needed, shrink the RHS.
762 uint64_t Val = Demanded & OpC->getZExtValue();
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000763 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(OpC->getType(), Val));
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000764 return true;
765}
766
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000767// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
768// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
769// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
770// min/max.
771static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
772 uint64_t KnownZero,
773 uint64_t KnownOne,
774 int64_t &Min, int64_t &Max) {
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000775 uint64_t TypeBits = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitMask();
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000776 uint64_t UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne) & TypeBits;
777
778 uint64_t SignBit = 1ULL << (Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
779
780 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
781 // bit if it is unknown.
782 Min = KnownOne;
783 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
784
785 if (SignBit & UnknownBits) { // Sign bit is unknown
786 Min |= SignBit;
787 Max &= ~SignBit;
788 }
789
790 // Sign extend the min/max values.
791 int ShAmt = 64-Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
792 Min = (Min << ShAmt) >> ShAmt;
793 Max = (Max << ShAmt) >> ShAmt;
794}
795
796// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
797// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
798// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
799// min/max.
800static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
801 uint64_t KnownZero,
802 uint64_t KnownOne,
803 uint64_t &Min,
804 uint64_t &Max) {
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000805 uint64_t TypeBits = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitMask();
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000806 uint64_t UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne) & TypeBits;
807
808 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
809 Min = KnownOne;
810 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
811 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
812}
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000813
814
815/// SimplifyDemandedBits - Look at V. At this point, we know that only the
816/// DemandedMask bits of the result of V are ever used downstream. If we can
817/// use this information to simplify V, do so and return true. Otherwise,
818/// analyze the expression and return a mask of KnownOne and KnownZero bits for
819/// the expression (used to simplify the caller). The KnownZero/One bits may
820/// only be accurate for those bits in the DemandedMask.
821bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedMask,
822 uint64_t &KnownZero, uint64_t &KnownOne,
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000823 unsigned Depth) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000824 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000825 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
826 KnownOne = CI->getZExtValue() & DemandedMask;
827 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
828 return false;
829 }
830
831 KnownZero = KnownOne = 0;
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000832 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000833 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
834 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
835 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000836 return false;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000837 }
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000838 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000839 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000840 DemandedMask = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitMask();
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000841 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
Chris Lattner92a68652006-02-07 08:05:22 +0000842 if (V != UndefValue::get(V->getType()))
843 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(V->getType()));
844 return false;
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000845 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
846 return false;
847 }
848
849 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
850 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
851
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +0000852 DemandedMask &= cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitMask();
Chris Lattnerfb296922006-05-04 17:33:35 +0000853
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000854 uint64_t KnownZero2 = 0, KnownOne2 = 0;
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000855 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
856 default: break;
857 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000858 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
859 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
860 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
861 return true;
862 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
863
864 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
865 // LHS.
866 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~KnownZero,
867 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
868 return true;
869 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
870
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000871 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000872 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
873 if ((DemandedMask & ~KnownZero2 & KnownOne) == (DemandedMask & ~KnownZero2))
874 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
875 if ((DemandedMask & ~KnownZero & KnownOne2) == (DemandedMask & ~KnownZero))
876 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000877
878 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
879 if ((DemandedMask & (KnownZero|KnownZero2)) == DemandedMask)
880 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I->getType()));
881
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000882 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000883 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~KnownZero2))
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000884 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
885
886 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
887 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
888 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
889 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
890 break;
891 case Instruction::Or:
892 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
893 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
894 return true;
895 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
896 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~KnownOne,
897 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
898 return true;
899 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
900
901 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
902 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
Jeff Cohen0add83e2006-02-18 03:20:33 +0000903 if ((DemandedMask & ~KnownOne2 & KnownZero) == (DemandedMask & ~KnownOne2))
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000904 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Jeff Cohen0add83e2006-02-18 03:20:33 +0000905 if ((DemandedMask & ~KnownOne & KnownZero2) == (DemandedMask & ~KnownOne))
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000906 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000907
908 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
909 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
910 if ((DemandedMask & (~KnownZero) & KnownOne2) ==
911 (DemandedMask & (~KnownZero)))
912 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Nate Begeman8a77efe2006-02-16 21:11:51 +0000913 if ((DemandedMask & (~KnownZero2) & KnownOne) ==
914 (DemandedMask & (~KnownZero2)))
915 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000916
917 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
918 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
919 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
920
921 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
922 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
923 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
924 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
925 break;
926 case Instruction::Xor: {
927 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
928 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
929 return true;
930 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
931 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
932 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
933 return true;
934 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
935
936 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
937 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
938 if ((DemandedMask & KnownZero) == DemandedMask)
939 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
940 if ((DemandedMask & KnownZero2) == DemandedMask)
941 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
942
943 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
944 uint64_t KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
945 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
946 uint64_t KnownOneOut = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
947
Chris Lattner8e9a7b72006-11-27 19:55:07 +0000948 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
949 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000950 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattner8e9a7b72006-11-27 19:55:07 +0000951 if ((DemandedMask & ~KnownZero & ~KnownZero2) == 0) {
952 Instruction *Or =
953 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
954 I->getName());
955 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
956 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000957 }
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000958
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000959 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
960 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
961 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
962 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
963 if ((DemandedMask & (KnownZero|KnownOne)) == DemandedMask) { // all known
964 if ((KnownOne & KnownOne2) == KnownOne) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000965 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(I->getType(),
966 ~KnownOne & DemandedMask);
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000967 Instruction *And =
968 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
969 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
970 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
971 }
972 }
973
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000974 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
975 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
976 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
977 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
978
979 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
980 KnownOne = KnownOneOut;
981 break;
982 }
983 case Instruction::Select:
984 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
985 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
986 return true;
987 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
988 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
989 return true;
990 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
991 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
992
993 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
994 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
995 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
996 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
997 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
998
999 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1000 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
1001 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
1002 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001003 case Instruction::Trunc:
1004 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1005 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1006 return true;
1007 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1008 break;
1009 case Instruction::BitCast:
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00001010 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001011 return false;
Chris Lattner850465d2006-09-16 03:14:10 +00001012
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001013 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1014 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1015 return true;
1016 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1017 break;
1018 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1019 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001020 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1021 uint64_t NotIn = ~SrcTy->getBitMask();
1022 uint64_t NewBits = cast<IntegerType>(I->getType())->getBitMask() & NotIn;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001023
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001024 DemandedMask &= SrcTy->getBitMask();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001025 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1026 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1027 return true;
1028 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1029 // The top bits are known to be zero.
1030 KnownZero |= NewBits;
1031 break;
1032 }
1033 case Instruction::SExt: {
1034 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001035 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1036 uint64_t NotIn = ~SrcTy->getBitMask();
1037 uint64_t NewBits = cast<IntegerType>(I->getType())->getBitMask() & NotIn;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001038
1039 // Get the sign bit for the source type
1040 uint64_t InSignBit = 1ULL << (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001041 int64_t InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask & SrcTy->getBitMask();
Chris Lattner7d852282006-02-13 22:41:07 +00001042
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001043 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1044 // bit is demanded.
1045 if (NewBits & DemandedMask)
1046 InputDemandedBits |= InSignBit;
Chris Lattner7d852282006-02-13 22:41:07 +00001047
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001048 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1049 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1050 return true;
1051 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001052
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001053 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1054 // top bits of the result.
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001055
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001056 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1057 // convert this into a zero extension.
1058 if ((KnownZero & InSignBit) || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits) {
1059 // Convert to ZExt cast
1060 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(
1061 Instruction::ZExt, I->getOperand(0), I->getType(), I->getName(), I);
1062 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
1063 } else if (KnownOne & InSignBit) { // Input sign bit known set
1064 KnownOne |= NewBits;
1065 KnownZero &= ~NewBits;
1066 } else { // Input sign bit unknown
1067 KnownZero &= ~NewBits;
1068 KnownOne &= ~NewBits;
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001069 }
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001070 break;
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001071 }
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001072 case Instruction::Add:
1073 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1074 // we can do.
1075 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1076 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1077 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1078 if (RHS->isNullValue())
1079 break;
1080
1081 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1082 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1083 // either.
1084
1085 // Shift the demanded mask up so that it's at the top of the uint64_t.
1086 unsigned BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
1087 unsigned NLZ = CountLeadingZeros_64(DemandedMask << (64-BitWidth));
1088
1089 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1090 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Jeff Cohen223004c2007-01-08 20:17:17 +00001091 uint64_t InDemandedBits = ~0ULL >> (64-BitWidth+NLZ);
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001092
1093 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1094 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1095 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1096 return true;
1097
1098 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1099 // the constant.
1100 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1101 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1102
1103 // Avoid excess work.
1104 if (KnownZero2 == 0 && KnownOne2 == 0)
1105 break;
1106
1107 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1108 if ((KnownZero2 & RHS->getZExtValue()) == RHS->getZExtValue()) {
1109 Instruction *Or =
1110 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1111 I->getName());
1112 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1113 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1114 }
1115
1116 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1117 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1118 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1119 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1120 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1121
1122 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1123 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1124 // this scan.
1125 uint64_t RHSVal = RHS->getZExtValue();
1126
1127 bool CarryIn = false;
1128 uint64_t CarryBits = 0;
1129 uint64_t CurBit = 1;
1130 for (unsigned i = 0; i != BitWidth; ++i, CurBit <<= 1) {
1131 // Record the current carry in.
1132 if (CarryIn) CarryBits |= CurBit;
1133
1134 bool CarryOut;
1135
1136 // This bit has a carry out unless it is "zero + zero" or
1137 // "zero + anything" with no carry in.
1138 if ((KnownZero2 & CurBit) && ((RHSVal & CurBit) == 0)) {
1139 CarryOut = false; // 0 + 0 has no carry out, even with carry in.
1140 } else if (!CarryIn &&
1141 ((KnownZero2 & CurBit) || ((RHSVal & CurBit) == 0))) {
1142 CarryOut = false; // 0 + anything has no carry out if no carry in.
1143 } else {
1144 // Otherwise, we have to assume we have a carry out.
1145 CarryOut = true;
1146 }
1147
1148 // This stage's carry out becomes the next stage's carry-in.
1149 CarryIn = CarryOut;
1150 }
1151
1152 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1153
1154 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1155 // other, and there is no input carry.
1156 KnownOne = ((KnownZero2 & RHSVal) | (KnownOne2 & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1157
1158 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1159 // is no input carry.
1160 KnownZero = KnownZero2 & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1161 }
1162 break;
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001163 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001164 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1165 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
1166 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask >> ShiftAmt,
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001167 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1168 return true;
1169 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001170 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1171 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1172 KnownZero |= (1ULL << ShiftAmt) - 1; // low bits known zero.
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001173 }
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001174 break;
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001175 case Instruction::LShr:
1176 // For a logical shift right
1177 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1178 unsigned ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
1179
1180 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
1181 uint64_t HighBits = (1ULL << ShiftAmt)-1;
1182 HighBits <<= I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() - ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001183 uint64_t TypeMask = cast<IntegerType>(I->getType())->getBitMask();
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001184 // Unsigned shift right.
1185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
1186 (DemandedMask << ShiftAmt) & TypeMask,
1187 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1188 return true;
1189 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1190 KnownZero &= TypeMask;
1191 KnownOne &= TypeMask;
1192 KnownZero >>= ShiftAmt;
1193 KnownOne >>= ShiftAmt;
1194 KnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::AShr:
Chris Lattner420c4bc2006-09-18 04:31:40 +00001198 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1199 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1200 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1201 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001202 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1203 // Perform the logical shift right.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001204 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001205 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Reid Spencer00c482b2006-10-26 19:19:06 +00001206 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
Chris Lattner420c4bc2006-09-18 04:31:40 +00001207 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1208 }
1209
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001210 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1211 unsigned ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001212
1213 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001214 uint64_t HighBits = (1ULL << ShiftAmt)-1;
1215 HighBits <<= I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() - ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001216 uint64_t TypeMask = cast<IntegerType>(I->getType())->getBitMask();
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001217 // Signed shift right.
1218 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
1219 (DemandedMask << ShiftAmt) & TypeMask,
1220 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1))
1221 return true;
1222 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1223 KnownZero &= TypeMask;
1224 KnownOne &= TypeMask;
1225 KnownZero >>= ShiftAmt;
1226 KnownOne >>= ShiftAmt;
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001227
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001228 // Handle the sign bits.
1229 uint64_t SignBit = 1ULL << (I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
1230 SignBit >>= ShiftAmt; // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001231
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001232 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1233 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
1234 if ((KnownZero & SignBit) || (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1235 // Perform the logical shift right.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001236 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001237 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001238 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1239 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1240 } else if (KnownOne & SignBit) { // New bits are known one.
1241 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001242 }
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001243 }
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001244 break;
1245 }
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00001246
1247 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1248 // constant.
1249 if ((DemandedMask & (KnownZero|KnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00001250 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), KnownOne));
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +00001251 return false;
1252}
1253
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001254
1255/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1256/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1257/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1258/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1259///
1260/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1261/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1262/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1263Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1264 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1265 unsigned Depth) {
1266 unsigned VWidth = cast<PackedType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
1267 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1268 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1269 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1270 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1271
1272 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1273 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1274 UndefElts = EltMask;
1275 return 0;
1276 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1277 UndefElts = EltMask;
1278 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1279 }
1280
1281 UndefElts = 0;
1282 if (ConstantPacked *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantPacked>(V)) {
1283 const Type *EltTy = cast<PackedType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
1284 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1285
1286 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1287 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1288 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1289 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1290 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1291 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1292 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1293 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1294 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1295 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1296 }
1297
1298 // If we changed the constant, return it.
1299 Constant *NewCP = ConstantPacked::get(Elts);
1300 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1301 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
1302 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantPacked where the non-demanded elements are
1303 // set to undef.
1304 const Type *EltTy = cast<PackedType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
1305 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1306 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1307 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1308 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1309 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1310 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
1311 return ConstantPacked::get(Elts);
1312 }
1313
1314 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1315 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1316 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1317 return false;
1318 }
1319 return false;
1320 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1321 return false;
1322 }
1323
1324 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1325 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1326
1327 bool MadeChange = false;
1328 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1329 Value *TmpV;
1330 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1331 default: break;
1332
1333 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1334 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1335 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001336 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001337 if (Idx == 0) {
1338 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1339 // which elt is getting updated.
1340 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1341 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1342 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1343 break;
1344 }
1345
1346 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1347 // insertelement.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001348 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001349 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1350 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1351
1352 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1353 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1354 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1355 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1356 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1357 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1358
1359 // The inserted element is defined.
1360 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1361 break;
1362 }
1363
1364 case Instruction::And:
1365 case Instruction::Or:
1366 case Instruction::Xor:
1367 case Instruction::Add:
1368 case Instruction::Sub:
1369 case Instruction::Mul:
1370 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1371 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1372 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1373 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1374 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1375 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1376 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1377
1378 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1379 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1380 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1381 break;
1382
1383 case Instruction::Call: {
1384 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1385 if (!II) break;
1386 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1387 default: break;
1388
1389 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1390 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1391 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1392 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1393 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1394 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1395 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1396 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1397 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1398 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1399 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1400 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1401 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1402 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1403 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1404 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1405
1406 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1407 // scalarize it now.
1408 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1409 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1410 default: break;
1411 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1412 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1413 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1414 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1415 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1416 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1417 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1418 // Extract the element as scalars.
1419 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1420 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1421
1422 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1423 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1424 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1425 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1426 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1427 II->getName()), *II);
1428 break;
1429 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1430 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1431 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1432 II->getName()), *II);
1433 break;
1434 }
1435
1436 Instruction *New =
1437 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1438 II->getName());
1439 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1440 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1441 return New;
1442 }
1443 }
1444
1445 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1446 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1447 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1448 break;
1449 }
1450 break;
1451 }
1452 }
1453 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1454}
1455
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001456/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1457/// true when both operands are equal...
1458/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true if both operands are equal
1459static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1460 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = ICI.getPredicate();
1461 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1462 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1463 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1464}
1465
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001466/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1467/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1468/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1469/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1470/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1471/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1472/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1473///
1474template<typename Functor>
1475Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1476 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1477 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1478
1479 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1480 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1481 return F.apply(Root);
1482
1483 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1484 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001485 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001486 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1487 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1488
1489 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1490 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1491 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1492 ShouldApply = true;
1493 }
1494
1495 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1496 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1497 if (ShouldApply) {
1498 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001499
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001500 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1501 // and perform the reassociation.
1502 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1503
1504 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1505 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1506
1507 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1508 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001509 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001510 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1511 return 0;
1512 }
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001513 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001514 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001515 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1516 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1517 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1518 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001519
1520 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1521 // get to LHSI.
1522 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1523 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001524 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1525 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1526 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1527 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1528 ARI = NextLHSI;
1529
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001530 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1531 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1532 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1533 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1534 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001535
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001536 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1537 // the transformation...
1538 return F.apply(Root);
1539 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001540
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001541 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1542 }
1543 return 0;
1544}
1545
1546
1547// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1548struct AddRHS {
1549 Value *RHS;
1550 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1551 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1552 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001553 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001554 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001555 }
1556};
1557
1558// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1559// iff C1&C2 == 0
1560struct AddMaskingAnd {
1561 Constant *C2;
1562 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1563 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001564 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001565 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001566 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001567 }
1568 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001569 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001570 }
1571};
1572
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001573static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001574 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001575 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001576 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001577 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001578
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001579 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1580 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001581 }
1582
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001583 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001584 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1585 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001586
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001587 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1588 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001589 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1590 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001591 }
1592
1593 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1594 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1595 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1596 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001597 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1598 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001599 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1600 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1601 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001602 else {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001603 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001604 abort();
1605 }
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001606 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1607}
1608
1609// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1610// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1611// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1612// not have a second operand.
1613static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1614 InstCombiner *IC) {
1615 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1616 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1617 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1618 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1619
1620 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001621 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001622 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001623
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001624 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1625 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1626
1627 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1628 SelectFalseVal);
1629 }
1630 return 0;
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001631}
1632
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001633
1634/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1635/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1636/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1637Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1638 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001639 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001640 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001641
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001642 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1643 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
1644 // bail out.
1645 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1646 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1647 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1648 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
1649 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1650
1651 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1652 // loop.
1653 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1654 return 0;
1655 }
1656
1657 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1658 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1659 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1660 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1661 if (NonConstBB) {
1662 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1663 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1664 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001665
1666 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
1667 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), I.getName());
1668 I.setName("");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001669 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001670 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
1671
1672 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1673 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1674 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001675 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001676 Value *InV;
1677 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001678 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1679 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1680 else
1681 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001682 } else {
1683 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1684 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1685 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1686 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1687 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001688 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1689 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1690 CI->getPredicate(),
1691 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1692 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001693 else
1694 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1695
1696 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(InV));
1697 }
1698 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001699 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001700 } else {
1701 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1702 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001703 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001704 Value *InV;
1705 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001706 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001707 } else {
1708 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001709 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1710 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1711 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001712 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(InV));
1713 }
1714 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001715 }
1716 }
1717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1718}
1719
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001720Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001721 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001722 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001723
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001724 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001725 // X + undef -> undef
1726 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1727 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1728
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001729 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001730 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001731 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattnerda1b1522005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001733 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
1734 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(-0.0))
1735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001736 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001737
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001738 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001739 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Chris Lattner92a68652006-02-07 08:05:22 +00001740 uint64_t Val = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner77defba2006-02-07 07:00:41 +00001741 if (Val == (1ULL << (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001742 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001743
1744 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1745 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
1746 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
1747 if (!isa<PackedType>(I.getType()) &&
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001748 SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitMask(),
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001749 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1750 return &I;
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001751 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001752
1753 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1754 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1755 return NV;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001756
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001757 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1758 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001759 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1760 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001761 unsigned TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
1762 int64_t RHSSExt = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getSExtValue();
1763 uint64_t RHSZExt = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getZExtValue();
1764
1765 uint64_t C0080Val = 1ULL << 31;
1766 int64_t CFF80Val = -C0080Val;
1767 unsigned Size = 32;
1768 do {
1769 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
1770 bool Found = false;
1771 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1772 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
1773 if (RHSSExt == CFF80Val) {
1774 if (XorRHS->getZExtValue() == C0080Val)
1775 Found = true;
1776 } else if (RHSZExt == C0080Val) {
1777 if (XorRHS->getSExtValue() == CFF80Val)
1778 Found = true;
1779 }
1780 if (Found) {
1781 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +00001782 uint64_t Mask = ~0ULL;
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00001783 Mask <<= 64-(TySizeBits-Size);
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001784 Mask &= cast<IntegerType>(XorLHS->getType())->getBitMask();
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00001785 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001786 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
1787 goto FoundSExt;
1788 }
1789 }
1790 Size >>= 1;
1791 C0080Val >>= Size;
1792 CFF80Val >>= Size;
1793 } while (Size >= 8);
1794
1795FoundSExt:
1796 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1797 switch (Size) {
1798 default: break;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00001799 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1800 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1801 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001802 }
1803 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001804 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001805 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001806 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType());
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001807 }
1808 }
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001809 }
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001810
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001811 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00001812 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001813 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00001814
1815 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
1816 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1817 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
1818 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
1819 }
1820 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
1821 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1822 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
1823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
1824 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00001825 }
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00001826
Chris Lattner147e9752002-05-08 22:46:53 +00001827 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001828 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001829 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001830
1831 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001832 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
1833 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001834 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00001835
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001836
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001837 ConstantInt *C2;
1838 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
1839 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
1840 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
1841
1842 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
1843 ConstantInt *C1;
1844 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
1845 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, ConstantExpr::getAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00001846 }
1847
1848 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001849 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
1850 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
1851
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00001852 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
1853 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
1854 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
1855 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
1856
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00001857
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001858 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001859 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00001860 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
1861 return R;
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +00001862
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00001863 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001864 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001865 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) { // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
1866 Constant *C= ConstantExpr::getSub(CRHS, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
1867 return BinaryOperator::createSub(C, X);
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00001868 }
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001869
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001870 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
1871 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
1872 Constant *Anded = ConstantExpr::getAnd(CRHS, C2);
1873 if (Anded == CRHS) {
1874 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
1875 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001876 uint64_t AddRHSV = CRHS->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001877
1878 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
1879 uint64_t AddRHSHighBits = ~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1);
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00001880 AddRHSHighBits &= C2->getType()->getBitMask();
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001881
1882 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001883 uint64_t AddRHSHighBitsAnd = AddRHSHighBits & C2->getZExtValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001884
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00001885 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
1886 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
1887 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
1888 LHS->getName()), I);
1889 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
1890 }
1891 }
1892 }
1893
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001894 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
1895 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001896 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001897 return R;
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00001898 }
1899
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00001900 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
1901 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
1902 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00001903 {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001904 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
1905 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00001906 if (!CI) {
1907 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
1908 Other = LHS;
1909 }
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00001910 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00001911 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
1912 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00001913 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00001914 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00001915 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00001916 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001917 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00001918 }
1919 }
1920
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001921 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00001922}
1923
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00001924// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
1925// highest order bit set.
1926static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00001927 unsigned NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001928 return (CI->getZExtValue() & (~0ULL >> (64-NumBits))) == (1ULL << (NumBits-1));
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00001929}
1930
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001931Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001932 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001933
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001934 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
1935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00001936
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001937 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001938 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001939 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001940
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001941 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
1942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
1943 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
1944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
1945
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00001946 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
1947 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001948 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
1949 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00001950
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00001951 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00001952 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001953 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
1954 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X,
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001955 ConstantExpr::getAdd(C, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)));
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00001956 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
1957 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00001958 if (C->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001959 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001960 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001961 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00001962 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001963 if (CU->getZExtValue() ==
1964 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001965 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001966 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
1967 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00001968 }
1969 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001970 }
1971 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
1972 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
1973 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
1974 if (CU->getZExtValue() ==
1975 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00001976 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001977 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001978 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00001979 }
1980 }
1981 }
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00001982 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001983
1984 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
1985 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001986 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001987 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001988
1989 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
1990 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1991 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00001992 }
1993
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00001994 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
1995 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001996 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00001997 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00001998 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00001999 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002000 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002001 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2002 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2003 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
2004 return BinaryOperator::createSub(ConstantExpr::getSub(CI1, CI2),
2005 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2006 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002007 }
2008
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002009 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002010 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2011 // is not used by anyone else...
2012 //
Chris Lattnerc2f0aa52004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002013 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002014 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002015 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2016 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2017 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2018 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002019
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002020 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002021 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002022 }
2023
2024 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2025 //
2026 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2027 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2028 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2029
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002030 Value *NewNot =
2031 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002032 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002033 }
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002034
Reid Spencer3c514952006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002035 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002036 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002037 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002038 if (CSI->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002039 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002040 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002041 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2042
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002043 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002044 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002045 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002046 Constant *CP1 =
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002047 ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002048 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002049 }
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002050 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002051 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002052
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002053 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002054 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2055 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002056 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2057 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2058 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2059 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002060 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2061 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2062 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002063 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002064
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002065 ConstantInt *C1;
2066 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
2067 if (X == Op1) { // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2068 Constant *CP1 = ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(),1));
2069 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, CP1);
2070 }
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002071
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002072 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2073 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
2074 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, C2));
2075 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002076 return 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002077}
2078
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002079/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if it
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002080/// really just returns true if the most significant (sign) bit is set.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002081static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS) {
2082 switch (pred) {
2083 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
2084 // True if LHS s< RHS and RHS == 0
2085 return RHS->isNullValue();
2086 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
2087 // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2088 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
2089 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2090 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2091 return RHS->getZExtValue() == (1ULL <<
2092 (RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1));
2093 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2094 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2095 return RHS->getZExtValue() ==
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002096 (1ULL << (RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1))-1;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002097 default:
2098 return false;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002099 }
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002100}
2101
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002102Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002103 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002104 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002105
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002106 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2107 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2108
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002109 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002110 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2111 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002112
2113 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002114 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002115 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2116 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002117 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2118 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002119
Chris Lattnercce81be2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002120 if (CI->isNullValue())
2121 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2122 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2123 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2124 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner35236d82003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002125 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002126
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002127 int64_t Val = (int64_t)cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002128 if (isPowerOf2_64(Val)) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
2129 uint64_t C = Log2_64(Val);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002130 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002131 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C));
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002132 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002133 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002134 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2135 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002136
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002137 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2138 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2139 if (Op1F->getValue() == 1.0)
2140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2141 }
Chris Lattner32c01df2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002142
2143 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2144 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2145 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2146 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2147 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2148 Op1, "tmp");
2149 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2150 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2151 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2152 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2153
2154 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002155
2156 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2157 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002158 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002159 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002160
2161 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2162 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2163 return NV;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002164 }
2165
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002166 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2167 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002168 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002169
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002170 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2171 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2172 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2173 // formed.
2174 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002175 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002176 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002177 BoolCast = CI;
2178 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002179 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002180 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002181 BoolCast = CI;
2182 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002183 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002184 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2185 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
2186
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002187 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002188 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2189 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002190 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002191 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002192 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002193 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002194 Value *V =
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002195 InsertNewInstBefore(
2196 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002197 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2198 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002199
2200 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2201 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002202 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
2203 unsigned SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2204 unsigned DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2205 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2206 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2207 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2208 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2209 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002210
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002211 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002212 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002213 }
2214 }
2215 }
2216
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002217 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002218}
2219
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002220/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2221/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2222/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2223/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002224Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002225 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002226
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002227 // undef / X -> 0
2228 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002229 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002230
2231 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002232 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002234
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002235 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002236 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2237 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002238 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2239 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002240 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002241 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002242 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2243 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2244 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2245 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002246 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002247 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2248 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2249 else
2250 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2251 return &I;
2252 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002253
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002254 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2255 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2256 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2257 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2258 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002259 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002260 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2261 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2262 else
2263 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2264 return &I;
2265 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002266 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002267
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002268 return 0;
2269}
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002270
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002271/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2272/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2273/// division instructions.
2274/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002275Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002276 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2277
2278 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2279 return Common;
2280
2281 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2282 // div X, 1 == X
2283 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2285
2286 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2287 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2288 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2289 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2290 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
2291 ConstantExpr::getMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattner42362612005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002292 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002293
2294 if (!RHS->isNullValue()) { // avoid X udiv 0
2295 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2296 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2297 return R;
2298 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2299 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2300 return NV;
2301 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002302 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002303
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002304 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002305 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002306 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2308
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002309 return 0;
2310}
2311
2312Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2313 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2314
2315 // Handle the integer div common cases
2316 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2317 return Common;
2318
2319 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2320 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2321 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2322 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2323 if (uint64_t Val = C->getZExtValue()) // Don't break X / 0
2324 if (isPowerOf2_64(Val)) {
2325 uint64_t ShiftAmt = Log2_64(Val);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002326 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002327 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002328 }
2329 }
2330
2331 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002332 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002333 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2334 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
2335 uint64_t C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getZExtValue();
2336 if (isPowerOf2_64(C1)) {
2337 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002338 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002339 if (uint64_t C2 = Log2_64(C1)) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002340 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2341 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002342 }
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002343 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002344 }
2345 }
Chris Lattnerdd0c1742005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002346 }
2347
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002348 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2349 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2350 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2351 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2352 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2353 if (!STO->isNullValue() && !STO->isNullValue()) {
2354 uint64_t TVA = STO->getZExtValue(), FVA = SFO->getZExtValue();
2355 if (isPowerOf2_64(TVA) && isPowerOf2_64(FVA)) {
2356 // Compute the shift amounts
2357 unsigned TSA = Log2_64(TVA), FSA = Log2_64(FVA);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002358 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002359 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002360 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002361 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002362 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2363
2364 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002365 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002366 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002367 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002368 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
2369
2370 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002371 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002372 }
2373 }
2374 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002375 return 0;
2376}
2377
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002378Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2379 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2380
2381 // Handle the integer div common cases
2382 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2383 return Common;
2384
2385 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2386 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2387 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2388 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2389
2390 // -X/C -> X/-C
2391 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2392 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2393 }
2394
2395 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2396 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002397 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002398 uint64_t Mask = 1ULL << (I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
2399 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2400 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2401 }
2402 }
2403
2404 return 0;
2405}
2406
2407Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2408 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2409}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002410
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002411/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2412/// of some factor, return that factor.
2413static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2414 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2415 return CI;
2416
2417 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2418 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2419
2420 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2421 if (!I) return Result;
2422
2423 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2424 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2425 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2426 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2427 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2428 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2429 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2430 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2431 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2432 }
2433 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2434 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2435 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
2436 unsigned Zeros = CountTrailingZeros_64(RHS->getZExtValue());
2437 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2438 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002439 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002440 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002441 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002442 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002443 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2444 return Result;
2445 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2446 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002447 }
2448 return Result;
2449}
2450
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002451/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2452/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2453/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2454/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2455Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002456 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002457
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002458 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2459 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2460 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2462
2463 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2464 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2465 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002467
2468 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2469 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2470 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2471 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2472 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2473 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2474 // simplified also.
2475 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2476 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2477 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2478 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002479 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002480 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2481 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2482 else
2483 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002484 return &I;
2485 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002486 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2487 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2488 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2489 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2490 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002491 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002492 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2493 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2494 else
2495 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2496 return &I;
2497 }
Chris Lattnere9ff0ea2005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002498 }
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002499
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002500 return 0;
2501}
2502
2503/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2504/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2505/// remainder instructions.
2506/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2507Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2508 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2509
2510 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2511 return common;
2512
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002513 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002514 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2515 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2517
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002518 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2520
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002521 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2522 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2523 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2524 return R;
2525 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2526 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2527 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002528 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002529 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2530 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002531 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002532 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002533 }
2534
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002535 return 0;
2536}
2537
2538Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2539 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2540
2541 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2542 return common;
2543
2544 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2545 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2546 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2547 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2548 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
2549 if (isPowerOf2_64(C->getZExtValue()))
2550 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2551 }
2552
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002553 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002554 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2555 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2556 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002557 unsigned C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002558 if (isPowerOf2_64(C1)) {
2559 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2560 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2561 "tmp"), I);
2562 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2563 }
2564 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002565 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002566
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002567 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2568 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2569 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2570 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2571 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2572 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
2573 if (isPowerOf2_64(STO->getZExtValue()) &&
2574 isPowerOf2_64(SFO->getZExtValue())) {
2575 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2576 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2577 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2578 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2579 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2580 }
2581 }
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002582 }
2583
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002584 return 0;
2585}
2586
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002587Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2588 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2589
2590 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2591 return common;
2592
2593 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2594 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
2595 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getSExtValue() > 0) {
2596 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2597 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2598 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2599 return &I;
2600 }
2601
2602 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2603 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
2604 uint64_t Mask = 1ULL << (I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
2605 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2606 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2607 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2608 }
2609
2610 return 0;
2611}
2612
2613Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002614 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2615}
2616
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002617// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002618static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
2619 if (isSigned) {
2620 // Calculate 0111111111..11111
2621 unsigned TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2622 int64_t Val = INT64_MAX; // All ones
2623 Val >>= 64-TypeBits; // Shift out unwanted 1 bits...
2624 return C->getSExtValue() == Val-1;
2625 }
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00002626 return C->getZExtValue() == C->getType()->getBitMask()-1;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002627}
2628
2629// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002630static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
2631 if (isSigned) {
2632 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2633 unsigned TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2634 int64_t Val = -1; // All ones
2635 Val <<= TypeBits-1; // Shift over to the right spot
2636 return C->getSExtValue() == Val+1;
2637 }
2638 return C->getZExtValue() == 1; // unsigned
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002639}
2640
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002641// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2642// constant.
2643static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002644 uint64_t V = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002645 return V && (V & (V-1)) == 0;
2646}
2647
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002648#if 0 // Currently unused
2649// isLowOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 0+1+.
2650static bool isLowOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002651 uint64_t V = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002652
2653 // There won't be bits set in parts that the type doesn't contain.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002654 V &= ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI->getType())->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002655
2656 uint64_t U = V+1; // If it is low ones, this should be a power of two.
2657 return U && V && (U & V) == 0;
2658}
2659#endif
2660
2661// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2662// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2663static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002664 uint64_t V = ~CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00002665 if (~V == 0) return false; // 0's does not match "1+"
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002666
2667 // There won't be bits set in parts that the type doesn't contain.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002668 V &= ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI->getType())->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002669
2670 uint64_t U = V+1; // If it is low ones, this should be a power of two.
2671 return U && V && (U & V) == 0;
2672}
2673
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002674/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002675/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2676///
2677/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2678///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002679/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2680/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002681///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002682/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2683/// 0 A > B
2684/// 1 A == B
2685/// 2 A < B
2686///
2687/// <=> Value Definition
2688/// 000 0 Always false
2689/// 001 1 A > B
2690/// 010 2 A == B
2691/// 011 3 A >= B
2692/// 100 4 A < B
2693/// 101 5 A != B
2694/// 110 6 A <= B
2695/// 111 7 Always true
2696///
2697static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2698 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002699 // False -> 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2701 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2702 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2703 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2705 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2706 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2707 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2709 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002710 // True -> 7
2711 default:
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002712 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002713 return 0;
2714 }
2715}
2716
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002717/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2718/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
2719/// new /// ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
2720/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2721static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2722 switch (code) {
2723 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002724 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002725 case 1:
2726 if (sign)
2727 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2728 else
2729 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2730 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2731 case 3:
2732 if (sign)
2733 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2734 else
2735 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2736 case 4:
2737 if (sign)
2738 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2739 else
2740 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2741 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2742 case 6:
2743 if (sign)
2744 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2745 else
2746 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002747 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002748 }
2749}
2750
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002751static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2752 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2753 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2754 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2755 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2756 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2757}
2758
2759namespace {
2760// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2761struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002762 InstCombiner &IC;
2763 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002764 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2765 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2766 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2767 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002768 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002769 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2770 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2771 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2772 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002773 return false;
2774 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002775 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2776 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2777 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2778 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2779 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002780 }
2781
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002782 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
2783 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002784 unsigned Code;
2785 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2786 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2787 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2788 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner2caaaba2003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002789 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002790 }
2791
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002792 Value *RV = getICmpValue(ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(pred), Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002793 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2794 return I;
2795 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2796 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2797 }
2798};
Chris Lattnere3a63d12006-11-15 04:53:24 +00002799} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002800
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002801// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
2802// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002803// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002804Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002805 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
2806 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002807 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
2808 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerfcf21a72004-01-12 19:47:05 +00002809 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002810 if (!Op->isShift())
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002811 Together = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002812
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002813 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
2814 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002815 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002816 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
2817 std::string OpName = Op->getName(); Op->setName("");
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002818 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS, OpName);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002819 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002820 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002821 }
2822 break;
2823 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002824 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
2825 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002826
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002827 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
2828 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
2829 std::string Op0Name = Op->getName(); Op->setName("");
2830 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together, Op0Name);
2831 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
2832 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002833 }
2834 break;
2835 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002836 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002837 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
2838 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
2839 // single bit constant.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002840 uint64_t AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002841
2842 // Clear bits that are not part of the constant.
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00002843 AndRHSV &= AndRHS->getType()->getBitMask();
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002844
2845 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002846 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002847 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
2848 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
2849 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002850 uint64_t AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getZExtValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002851
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002852 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
2853 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
2854 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
2855 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
2856 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
2857 // no effect.
2858 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
2859 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
2860 return &TheAnd;
2861 } else {
2862 std::string Name = Op->getName(); Op->setName("");
2863 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002864 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS, Name);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002865 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002866 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002867 }
2868 }
2869 }
2870 }
2871 break;
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002872
2873 case Instruction::Shl: {
2874 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
2875 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
2876 //
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002877 Constant *AllOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002878 Constant *ShlMask = ConstantExpr::getShl(AllOne, OpRHS);
2879 Constant *CI = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002880
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002881 if (CI == ShlMask) { // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
2882 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
2883 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002884 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
2885 return &TheAnd;
2886 }
2887 break;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002888 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002889 case Instruction::LShr:
2890 {
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002891 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
2892 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
2893 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
2894 //
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002895 Constant *AllOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002896 Constant *ShrMask = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AllOne, OpRHS);
2897 Constant *CI = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShrMask);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002898
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002899 if (CI == ShrMask) { // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
2900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
2901 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
2902 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
2903 return &TheAnd;
2904 }
2905 break;
2906 }
2907 case Instruction::AShr:
2908 // Signed shr.
2909 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
2910 // with an and.
2911 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002912 Constant *AllOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002913 Constant *ShrMask = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AllOne, OpRHS);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00002914 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShrMask);
2915 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002916 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002917 // Make the argument unsigned.
2918 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002919 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002920 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002921 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00002922 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002923 }
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002924 }
2925 break;
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002926 }
2927 return 0;
2928}
2929
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002930
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002931/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
2932/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002933/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
2934/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002935/// insert new instructions.
2936Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002937 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
2938 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002939 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00002940 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002941 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002942
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002943 if (Inside) {
2944 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002945 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002946
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002947 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002948 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002949 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
2950 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
2951 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
2952 }
2953
2954 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
2955 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
2956 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002957 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002958 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
2959 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002960 }
2961
2962 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002963 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002964
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002965 // V < Min || V >= Hi ->'V > Hi-1'
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002966 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002967 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002968 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
2969 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
2970 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
2971 }
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002972
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002973 // Emit V-Lo > Hi-1-Lo
2974 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
2975 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002976 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002977 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
2978 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002979}
2980
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00002981// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
2982// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
2983// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
2984// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002985static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, unsigned &MB, unsigned &ME) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002986 uint64_t V = Val->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00002987 if (!isShiftedMask_64(V)) return false;
2988
2989 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
2990 MB = 64-CountLeadingZeros_64((V - 1) ^ V);
2991 // look for the first non-zero bit
2992 ME = 64-CountLeadingZeros_64(V);
2993 return true;
2994}
2995
2996
2997
2998/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
2999/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3000/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003001///
3002/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3003/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3004/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3005///
3006/// return (A +/- B).
3007///
3008Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003009 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003010 Instruction &I) {
3011 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3012 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3013 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3014
3015 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3016
3017 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3018 default: return 0;
3019 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003020 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
3021 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003022 if ((Mask->getZExtValue() & Mask->getZExtValue()+1) == 0)
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003023 break;
3024
3025 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3026 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3027 // is all N is, ignore it.
3028 unsigned MB, ME;
3029 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00003030 uint64_t Mask = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitMask();
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003031 Mask >>= 64-MB+1;
3032 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003033 break;
3034 }
3035 }
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003036 return 0;
3037 case Instruction::Or:
3038 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003039 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003040 if ((Mask->getZExtValue() & Mask->getZExtValue()+1) == 0 &&
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003041 ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003042 break;
3043 return 0;
3044 }
3045
3046 Instruction *New;
3047 if (isSub)
3048 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3049 else
3050 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3051 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3052}
3053
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003054Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003055 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003056 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003057
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003058 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3059 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3060
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003061 // and X, X = X
3062 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003063 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003064
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003065 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003066 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +00003067 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003068 if (!isa<PackedType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00003069 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitMask(),
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003070 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003071 return &I;
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003072 } else {
3073 if (ConstantPacked *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantPacked>(Op1)) {
3074 if (CP->isAllOnesValue())
3075 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
3076 }
3077 }
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003078
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003079 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab2dc4d2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003080 uint64_t AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00003081 uint64_t TypeMask = cast<IntegerType>(Op0->getType())->getBitMask();
Chris Lattnerab2dc4d2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003082 uint64_t NotAndRHS = AndRHSMask^TypeMask;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003083
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003084 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003085 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003086 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003087 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3088 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3089 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3090 case Instruction::Xor:
3091 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003092 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3093 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3094 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3095 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3096 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3097 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3098 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3099 return BinaryOperator::create(
3100 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003101 }
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003102 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003103 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3104 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3105 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3106 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3107 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3108 return BinaryOperator::create(
3109 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3110 }
3111 }
3112
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003113 break;
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003114 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003115 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3116 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3117 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3118 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3119 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3120 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3121 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003122 break;
3123
3124 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003125 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3126 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3127 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3128 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3129 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003130 break;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003131 }
3132
Chris Lattner16464b32003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003133 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003134 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003135 return Res;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003136 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003137 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3138 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3139 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3140 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003141 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003142 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnerab2dc4d2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003143 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003144 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3145 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003146 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3147 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3148 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003149 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3150 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3151 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003152 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003153 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003154 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003155 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003156 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3157 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3158 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3159 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner2dc148e2006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003160 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003161 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3162 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3163 }
3164 }
Chris Lattner33217db2003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003165 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003166
3167 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3168 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003169 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003170 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003171 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3172 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3173 return NV;
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003174 }
3175
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003176 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3177 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003178
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003179 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3180 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3181
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003182 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003183 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003184 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3185 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003186 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003187 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3188 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003189
3190 {
3191 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003192 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3193 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3195 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3196 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3197 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003198
3199 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3200 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3201 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3202 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3203 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3204 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3205 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3206 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3207 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3208 }
3209 }
3210 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3211 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3212 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3213 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3214 std::swap(A, B);
3215 }
3216 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3217 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3218 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3219 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3220 }
3221 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003222 }
3223
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003224 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3225 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3226 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003227 return R;
3228
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003229 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3230 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003231 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3232 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3233 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3234 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3235 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3236 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3237 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3238 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3239 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003240 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003241 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3242 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3243 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3244 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003245 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003246 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3247 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3248 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3249 }
3250
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003251 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003252 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3253 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003254 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3255 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3256 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003257 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3258
3259 switch (LHSCC) {
3260 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003261 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003262 switch (RHSCC) {
3263 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003264 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3265 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3266 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003268 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3269 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3270 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3272 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003273 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003274 switch (RHSCC) {
3275 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003276 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3277 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3278 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3279 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3280 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3281 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3282 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3283 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3284 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3285 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3286 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003287 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003288 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3289 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003290 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3291 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3292 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3293 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattnerc8fb6de2007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003294 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3295 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003296 }
3297 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3298 }
3299 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003300 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003301 switch (RHSCC) {
3302 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003303 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3304 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003306 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3307 break;
3308 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3309 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003310 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003311 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3312 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003313 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003314 break;
3315 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003316 switch (RHSCC) {
3317 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003318 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3319 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003320 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003321 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3322 break;
3323 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3324 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003325 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003326 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3327 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003328 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003329 break;
3330 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3331 switch (RHSCC) {
3332 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3333 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3334 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3335 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3336 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3337 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3338 break;
3339 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3340 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3341 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3342 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3343 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3344 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3345 true, I);
3346 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3347 break;
3348 }
3349 break;
3350 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3351 switch (RHSCC) {
3352 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3353 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3355 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3356 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3357 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3358 break;
3359 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3360 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3361 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3362 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3363 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3364 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3365 true, I);
3366 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3367 break;
3368 }
3369 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003370 }
3371 }
3372 }
3373
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003374 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003375 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3376 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3377 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3378 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003379 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003380 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003381 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3382 I.getType(), TD) &&
3383 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3384 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003385 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3386 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3387 I.getName());
3388 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3389 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3390 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003391 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003392
3393 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003394 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3395 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3396 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003397 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3398 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3399 Instruction *NewOp =
3400 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3401 SI1->getOperand(0),
3402 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003403 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3404 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003405 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003406 }
3407
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003408 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003409}
3410
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003411/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3412/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3413/// yet, fill it in and return false.
3414static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, std::vector<Value*> &ByteValues) {
3415 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3416 if (I == 0) return true;
3417
3418 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3419 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3420 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3421 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3422
3423 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3424 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003425 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003426 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003427 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue() !=
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003428 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3429 return true;
3430
3431 unsigned DestNo;
3432 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3433 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3434 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3435 } else {
3436 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3437 DestNo = 0;
3438 }
3439
3440 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3441 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3442 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3443 return true;
3444 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3445 return false;
3446 }
3447
3448 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3449 // don't have this.
3450 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3451 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3452 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3453 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3454 return true;
3455 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3456
3457 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003458 if (ShiftAmt->getZExtValue() & 7 ||
3459 ShiftAmt->getZExtValue() > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003460 return true;
3461
3462 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3463 unsigned DestByte;
3464 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003465 if (AndAmt->getZExtValue() == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003466 break;
3467 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3468 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3469
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003470 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003471 unsigned SrcByte;
3472 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3473 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3474 else
3475 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3476
3477 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3478 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3479 return true;
3480
3481 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3482 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3483 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3484 return true;
3485 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3486 return false;
3487}
3488
3489/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3490/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3491Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003492 // We cannot bswap one byte.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003493 if (I.getType() == Type::Int8Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003494 return 0;
3495
3496 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3497 /// defines each byte.
3498 std::vector<Value*> ByteValues;
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00003499 ByteValues.resize(TD->getTypeSize(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003500
3501 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3502 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3503 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3504 return 0;
3505
3506 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3507 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3508 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3509
3510 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3511 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3512 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3513 return 0;
3514
3515 // If they do then *success* we can turn this into a bswap. Figure out what
3516 // bswap to make it into.
3517 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner091b6ea2006-07-11 18:31:26 +00003518 const char *FnName = 0;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003519 if (I.getType() == Type::Int16Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003520 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i16";
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003521 else if (I.getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003522 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i32";
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003523 else if (I.getType() == Type::Int64Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003524 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i64";
3525 else
3526 assert(0 && "Unknown integer type!");
Chris Lattnerfbc524f2007-01-07 06:58:05 +00003527 Constant *F = M->getOrInsertFunction(FnName, I.getType(), I.getType(), NULL);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003528 return new CallInst(F, V);
3529}
3530
3531
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003532Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003533 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003534 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003535
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003536 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3537 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // X | undef -> -1
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003538 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003539
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003540 // or X, X = X
3541 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003542 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003543
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003544 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3545 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
3546 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
Chris Lattnerd70d9f52006-03-25 21:58:26 +00003547 if (!isa<PackedType>(I.getType()) &&
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00003548 SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitMask(),
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003549 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3550 return &I;
3551
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003552 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003553 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003554 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003555 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3556 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003557 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS, Op0->getName());
3558 Op0->setName("");
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003559 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
3560 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, ConstantExpr::getOr(RHS, C1));
3561 }
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003562
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003563 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3564 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
3565 std::string Op0Name = Op0->getName(); Op0->setName("");
3566 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS, Op0Name);
3567 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
3568 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
3569 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS)));
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003570 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003571
3572 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3573 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003574 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003575 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003576 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3577 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3578 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003579 }
3580
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003581 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3582 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003583
3584 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3585 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3587 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3588 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3590
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003591 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3592 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003593 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003594 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3595 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3596 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003597 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3598 return BSwap;
3599 }
3600
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003601 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3602 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003603 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getZExtValue())) {
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003604 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1, Op0->getName());
3605 Op0->setName("");
3606 return BinaryOperator::createXor(InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I), C1);
3607 }
3608
3609 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3610 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003611 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getZExtValue())) {
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003612 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0, Op1->getName());
3613 Op0->setName("");
3614 return BinaryOperator::createXor(InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I), C1);
3615 }
3616
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003617 // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003618 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003619 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
3620
3621 if (A == B) // (A & C1)|(A & C2) == A & (C1|C2)
3622 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, ConstantExpr::getOr(C1, C2));
3623
3624
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003625 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3626 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3627 // replace with V+N.
3628 if (C1 == ConstantExpr::getNot(C2)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003629 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003630 if ((C2->getZExtValue() & (C2->getZExtValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003631 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3632 // Add commutes, try both ways.
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003633 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getZExtValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003634 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003635 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getZExtValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003636 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3637 }
3638 // Or commutes, try both ways.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003639 if ((C1->getZExtValue() & (C1->getZExtValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003640 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3641 // Add commutes, try both ways.
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003642 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getZExtValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003643 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003644 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getZExtValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003645 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003646 }
3647 }
3648 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003649
3650 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003651 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3652 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3653 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003654 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3655 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3656 Instruction *NewOp =
3657 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3658 SI1->getOperand(0),
3659 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003660 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3661 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003662 }
3663 }
Chris Lattner812aab72003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003664
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003665 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3666 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003668 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003669 } else {
3670 A = 0;
3671 }
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003672 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003673 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3674 if (Op0 == B)
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003676 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003677
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003678 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003679 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3680 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3681 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3682 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3683 }
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003684 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003685
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003686 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3687 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3688 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003689 return R;
3690
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003691 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3692 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003693 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3694 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3695 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3696 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3697 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3698 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3699 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3700 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3701 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003702 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003703 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3704 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3705 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3706 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003707 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003708 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3709 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3710 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3711 }
3712
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003713 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003714 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3715 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003716 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3717 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003718 // equal.
3719 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3720
3721 switch (LHSCC) {
3722 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003723 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003724 switch (RHSCC) {
3725 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003726 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003727 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3728 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3729 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3730 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3731 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003732 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003733 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003734 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003735 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3736 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
3737 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner5c219462005-04-19 06:04:18 +00003738 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003739 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3740 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
3741 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3743 }
3744 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003745 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003746 switch (RHSCC) {
3747 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
3749 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
3750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003752 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
3753 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
3754 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003756 }
3757 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003758 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003759 switch (RHSCC) {
3760 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003761 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003762 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003763 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
3764 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
3765 false, I);
3766 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3767 break;
3768 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3769 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003770 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003771 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3772 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003773 }
3774 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003775 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003776 switch (RHSCC) {
3777 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003778 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
3779 break;
3780 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
3781 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
3782 false, I);
3783 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3784 break;
3785 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3786 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
3787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3788 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3789 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003790 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003791 break;
3792 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3793 switch (RHSCC) {
3794 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3795 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
3796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
3797 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3798 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3799 break;
3800 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3801 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003803 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3804 break;
3805 }
3806 break;
3807 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3808 switch (RHSCC) {
3809 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3810 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
3811 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
3812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3813 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3814 break;
3815 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3816 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003818 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3819 break;
3820 }
3821 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003822 }
3823 }
3824 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003825
3826 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003827 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003828 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003829 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
3830 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003831 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003832 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003833 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3834 I.getType(), TD) &&
3835 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3836 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003837 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3838 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3839 I.getName());
3840 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3841 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3842 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003843 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003844
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003845
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003846 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003847}
3848
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003849// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
3850struct XorSelf {
3851 Value *RHS;
3852 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
3853 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
3854 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
3855 return &Xor;
3856 }
3857};
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003858
3859
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003860Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003861 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003862 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003863
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003864 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
3866
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003867 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
3868 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
3869 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?");
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003870 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003871 }
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003872
3873 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3874 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
3875 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
Chris Lattnerd70d9f52006-03-25 21:58:26 +00003876 if (!isa<PackedType>(I.getType()) &&
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00003877 SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitMask(),
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003878 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3879 return &I;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003880
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003881 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003882 // xor (icmp A, B), true = not (icmp A, B) = !icmp A, B
3883 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003884 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && ICI->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003885 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
3886 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00003887
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003888 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00003889 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003890 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
3891 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003892 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
3893 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003894 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003895 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003896 }
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003897
3898 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y)
3899 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
3900 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
3901 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
3902 Instruction *NotY =
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003903 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003904 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
3905 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
3906 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
3907 }
3908 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003909
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00003910 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003911 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00003912 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003913 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003914 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
3915 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
3916 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003917 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00003918 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003919 }
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00003920 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3921 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
3922 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getZExtValue())) {
3923 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
3924 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
3925 // NewRHS.
3926 Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
3927 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
3928 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
3929 WorkList.push_back(Op0I);
3930 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
3931 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
3932 return &I;
3933 }
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00003934 }
Chris Lattnerb8d6e402002-08-20 18:24:26 +00003935 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003936
3937 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3938 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003939 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003940 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003941 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3942 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3943 return NV;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003944 }
3945
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003946 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003947 if (X == Op1)
3948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003949 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003950
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003951 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003952 if (X == Op0)
3953 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003954 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003955
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003956 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00003957 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00003958 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003959 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00003960 I.swapOperands();
3961 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3962 } else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003963 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00003964 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003965 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00003966 } else if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor) {
3967 if (Op0 == Op1I->getOperand(0)) // A^(A^B) == B
3968 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1I->getOperand(1));
3969 else if (Op0 == Op1I->getOperand(1)) // A^(B^A) == B
3970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003971 } else if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
3972 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
3973 Op1I->swapOperands();
3974 if (Op0 == Op1I->getOperand(1)) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
3975 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
3976 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3977 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00003978 }
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00003979
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003980 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003981 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00003982 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003983 Op0I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003984 if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003985 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp");
3986 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003987 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0), NotB);
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00003988 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00003989 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor) {
3990 if (Op1 == Op0I->getOperand(0)) // (A^B)^A == B
3991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
3992 else if (Op1 == Op0I->getOperand(1)) // (B^A)^A == B
3993 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003994 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3995 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
3996 Op0I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6cf49142006-04-01 22:05:01 +00003997 if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
3998 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003999 Instruction *N = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(0), "tmp");
4000 InsertNewInstBefore(N, I);
4001 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4002 }
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004003 }
4004
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004005 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4006 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4007 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004008 return R;
4009
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004010 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004011 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004012 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004013 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4014 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004015 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004016 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004017 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4018 I.getType(), TD) &&
4019 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4020 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004021 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4022 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4023 I.getName());
4024 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4025 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4026 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004027 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004028
4029 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004030 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4031 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4032 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004033 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4034 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4035 Instruction *NewOp =
4036 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(SI0->getOperand(0),
4037 SI1->getOperand(0),
4038 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004039 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4040 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004041 }
4042 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004043
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004044 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004045}
4046
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004047static bool isPositive(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004048 return C->getSExtValue() >= 0;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004049}
4050
4051/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4052/// overflowed for this type.
4053static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4054 ConstantInt *In2) {
4055 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2));
4056
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00004057 return cast<ConstantInt>(Result)->getZExtValue() <
4058 cast<ConstantInt>(In1)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004059}
4060
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004061/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4062/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4063/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4064static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4065 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4066 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004067 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4068 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004069
4070 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner77defba2006-02-07 07:00:41 +00004071 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-TD.getPointerSize()*8);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004072
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004073 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4074 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattnerd35d2102005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004075 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004076 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004077 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
4078 if (!OpC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004079 OpC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004080 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4081 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4082 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4083 else {
4084 // Emit an add instruction.
4085 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4086 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4087 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4088 }
4089 }
4090 } else {
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004091 // Convert to correct type.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004092 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::createSExtOrBitCast(Op, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004093 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4094 if (Size != 1)
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004095 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4096 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4097 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004098
4099 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004100 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004101 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4102 }
4103 }
4104 return Result;
4105}
4106
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004107/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004108/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004109Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4110 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4111 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004112 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004113
4114 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4115 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4116 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4117
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004118 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4119 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4120 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004121 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4122 // each index is zero or not.
4123 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004124 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004125 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4126 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004127 bool EmitIt = true;
4128 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4129 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4130 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4131 if (C->isNullValue())
4132 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004133 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4134 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004135 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004136 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004137 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4138 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004139 }
4140
4141 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004142 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004143 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004144 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4145 if (InVal == 0)
4146 InVal = Comp;
4147 else {
4148 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4149 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004150 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004151 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4152 else // True if all are equal
4153 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4154 }
4155 }
4156 }
4157
4158 if (InVal)
4159 return InVal;
4160 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004161 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004162 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4163 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004164 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004165
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004166 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004167 // the result to fold to a constant!
4168 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4169 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4170 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004171 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4172 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004173 }
4174 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004175 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4176 // compare the base pointer.
4177 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4178 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004179 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattnerbd43b9d2005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004180 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004181 if (IndicesTheSame)
4182 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4183 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4184 IndicesTheSame = false;
4185 break;
4186 }
4187
4188 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4189 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004190 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4191 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004192
4193 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4194 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004195 return 0;
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004196 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004197
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004198 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4199 bool AllZeros = true;
4200 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4201 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4202 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4203 AllZeros = false;
4204 break;
4205 }
4206 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004207 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4208 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004209
4210 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004211 AllZeros = true;
4212 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4213 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4214 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4215 AllZeros = false;
4216 break;
4217 }
4218 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004219 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004220
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004221 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4222 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4223 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4224 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4225 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4226 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004227 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4228 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004229 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004230 NumDifferences = 2;
4231 break;
4232 } else {
4233 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4234 DiffOperand = i;
4235 }
4236 }
4237
4238 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4239 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004240 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4241 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004242 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004243 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4244 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004245 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4246 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004247 }
4248 }
4249
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004250 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004251 // the result to fold to a constant!
4252 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4253 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4254 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4255 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4256 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004257 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004258 }
4259 }
4260 return 0;
4261}
4262
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004263Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4264 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004265 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004266
Chris Lattner6ee923f2007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004267 // Fold trivial predicates.
4268 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4270 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4272
4273 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4274 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4275 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4276 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4277 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4278 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4279 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4281 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4282 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4283 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4285
4286 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4287 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4288 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4289 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4290 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4291 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4292 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4293 return &I;
4294
4295 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4296 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4297 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4298 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4299 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4300 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4301 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4302 return &I;
4303 }
4304 }
4305
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004306 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004308
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004309 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4310 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4311 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4312 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4313 case Instruction::PHI:
4314 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4315 return NV;
4316 break;
4317 case Instruction::Select:
4318 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4319 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4320 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4321 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4322 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4323 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4324 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4325 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4326 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4327 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4328 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4329 I.getName()), I);
4330 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4331 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4332 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4333 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4334 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4335 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4336 I.getName()), I);
4337 }
4338 }
4339
4340 if (Op1)
4341 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4342 break;
4343 }
4344 }
4345
4346 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4347}
4348
4349Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4350 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4351 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4352 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4353
4354 // icmp X, X
4355 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004356 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4357 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004358
4359 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004361
4362 // icmp of GlobalValues can never equal each other as long as they aren't
4363 // external weak linkage type.
4364 if (GlobalValue *GV0 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op0))
4365 if (GlobalValue *GV1 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op1))
4366 if (!GV0->hasExternalWeakLinkage() || !GV1->hasExternalWeakLinkage())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4368 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004369
4370 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004371 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004372 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4373 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4374 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004375 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004376 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4377 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004378
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004379 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004380 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004381 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4382 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4383 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004384 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004385 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004386 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004387 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004388 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004389 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004390
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004391 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4392 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4393 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004394 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004395 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4396 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004397 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4398 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4399 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4400 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004401 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4402 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4403 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004404 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004405 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4406 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004407 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4408 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4409 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4410 }
4411 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004412 }
4413
Chris Lattner2dd01742004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004414 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4415 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004416 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004417 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4418 default: break;
4419 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4420 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004421 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004422 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4423 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4424 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4425 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4426 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004427
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004428 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4429 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004430 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004431 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4432 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4433 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4434 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4435 break;
4436
4437 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4438 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004439 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004440 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4441 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4442 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4443 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4444 break;
4445
4446 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4447 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004448 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004449 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4450 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4451 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4452 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4453 break;
4454
4455 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4456 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004457 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004458 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4459 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4460 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4461 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4462 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004463
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004464 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4465 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004467 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4468 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4469 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4470 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4471 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004472
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004473 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4474 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004475 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004476 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4477 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4478 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4479 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4480 break;
4481
4482 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4483 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004485 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4486 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4487 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4488 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4489 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004490 }
4491
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004492 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4493 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004494 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4495 //
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004496 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
4497 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4498 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4499 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4500 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE)
4501 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4502 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
4503 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004504
4505 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
4506 // in the input.
4507 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00004508 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0, cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitMask(),
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004509 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4510 return &I;
4511
4512 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4513 // in.
4514 if (KnownOne | KnownZero) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004515 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4516 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Reid Spencer910f23f2006-12-23 19:17:57 +00004517 uint64_t UMin = 0, UMax = 0, URHSVal = 0;
4518 int64_t SMin = 0, SMax = 0, SRHSVal = 0;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004519 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
4520 SRHSVal = CI->getSExtValue();
4521 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, SMin,
4522 SMax);
4523 } else {
4524 URHSVal = CI->getZExtValue();
4525 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, UMin,
4526 UMax);
4527 }
4528 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4529 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4531 if (UMax < URHSVal || UMin > URHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004532 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004533 break;
4534 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4535 if (UMax < URHSVal || UMin > URHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004537 break;
4538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4539 if (UMax < URHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004541 if (UMin > URHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004542 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004543 break;
4544 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4545 if (UMin > URHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004546 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004547 if (UMax < URHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004548 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004549 break;
4550 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4551 if (SMax < SRHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004553 if (SMin > SRHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004554 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004555 break;
4556 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4557 if (SMin > SRHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004558 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004559 if (SMax < SRHSVal)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004561 break;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004562 }
4563 }
4564
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004565 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004566 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004567 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattnere1e10e12004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004568 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004569 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4570 case Instruction::And:
4571 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
4572 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004573 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
4574
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004575 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004576 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
4577 // produced, eliminating a cast.
4578 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
4579 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
4580 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
4581 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
4582 // bit would not work.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004583 if (Cast->hasOneUse() && isa<TruncInst>(Cast) &&
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004584 (I.isEquality() ||
4585 (AndCST->getZExtValue() == (uint64_t)AndCST->getSExtValue()) &&
4586 (CI->getZExtValue() == (uint64_t)CI->getSExtValue()))) {
4587 ConstantInt *NewCST;
4588 ConstantInt *NewCI;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00004589 NewCST = ConstantInt::get(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType(),
4590 AndCST->getZExtValue());
4591 NewCI = ConstantInt::get(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType(),
4592 CI->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004593 Instruction *NewAnd =
4594 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0), NewCST,
4595 LHSI->getName());
4596 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004597 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NewAnd, NewCI);
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004598 }
4599 }
4600
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004601 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
4602 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
4603 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
4604 // access.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004605 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
4606 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
4607 Shift = 0;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004608
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004609 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
4610 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004611 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
4612 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004613
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004614 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
4615 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
4616 // rights, as they sign-extend.
4617 if (ShAmt) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004618 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004619 if (!CanFold) {
4620 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
4621 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004622 int ShAmtVal = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-ShAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc53cb9d2005-06-17 01:29:28 +00004623 if (ShAmtVal < 0) ShAmtVal = 0; // Out of range shift.
4624
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004625 Constant *OShAmt = ConstantInt::get(AndTy, ShAmtVal);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004626 Constant *ShVal =
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004627 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndTy),
4628 OShAmt);
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004629 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(ShVal, AndCST)->isNullValue())
4630 CanFold = true;
4631 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004632
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004633 if (CanFold) {
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004634 Constant *NewCst;
4635 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004636 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004637 else
4638 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00004639
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004640 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
4641 // compared.
4642 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != CI){
4643 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
4644 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
4645 // result is always true or false now.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004646 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004647 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004648 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004650 } else {
4651 I.setOperand(1, NewCst);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004652 Constant *NewAndCST;
4653 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004654 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004655 else
4656 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
4657 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
Reid Spencer6ff3e732007-01-04 05:23:51 +00004658 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004659 WorkList.push_back(Shift); // Shift is dead.
4660 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
4661 return &I;
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00004662 }
4663 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00004664 }
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004665
4666 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
4667 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
4668 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
4669 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Chris Lattnerde077922006-09-18 18:27:05 +00004670 I.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
4671 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004672 // Compute C << Y.
4673 Value *NS;
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004674 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00004675 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004676 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004677 } else {
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00004678 // Insert a logical shift.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00004679 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004680 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004681 }
4682 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), I);
4683
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004684 // Compute X & (C << Y).
Reid Spencer6ff3e732007-01-04 05:23:51 +00004685 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(
4686 Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004687 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, I);
4688
4689 I.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
4690 return &I;
4691 }
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004692 }
4693 break;
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00004694
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004695 case Instruction::Shl: // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004696 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004697 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004698 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4699
4700 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
4701 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
4702 // simplified.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004703 if (ShAmt->getZExtValue() >= TypeBits)
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004704 break;
4705
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004706 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
4707 // comparison cannot succeed.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004708 Constant *Comp =
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004709 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt), ShAmt);
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004710 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004711 bool IsICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004712 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004713 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
4714 }
4715
4716 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4717 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004718 unsigned ShAmtVal = (unsigned)ShAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004719 uint64_t Val = (1ULL << (TypeBits-ShAmtVal))-1;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00004720 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004721
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004722 Instruction *AndI =
4723 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
4724 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
4725 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004726 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And,
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004727 ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004728 }
4729 }
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004730 }
4731 break;
4732
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004733 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004734 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004735 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004736 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004737 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
4738 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
4739 // simplified.
Chris Lattner104002b2005-06-16 01:52:07 +00004740 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004741 if (ShAmt->getZExtValue() >= TypeBits)
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004742 break;
4743
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004744 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
4745 // comparison cannot succeed.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004746 Constant *Comp;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00004747 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004748 Comp = ConstantExpr::getLShr(ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt),
4749 ShAmt);
4750 else
4751 Comp = ConstantExpr::getAShr(ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt),
4752 ShAmt);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004753
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004754 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004755 bool IsICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004756 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
4758 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004759
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004760 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || CI->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004761 unsigned ShAmtVal = (unsigned)ShAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004762
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004763 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
4764 uint64_t Val = ~0ULL; // All ones.
4765 Val <<= ShAmtVal; // Shift over to the right spot.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00004766 Val &= ~0ULL >> (64-TypeBits);
4767 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004768
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004769 Instruction *AndI =
4770 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
4771 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
4772 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004773 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And,
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004774 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt));
4775 }
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004776 }
4777 }
4778 break;
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00004779
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004780 case Instruction::SDiv:
4781 case Instruction::UDiv:
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004782 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004783 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
4784 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
4785 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
4786 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
4787 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004788 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004789 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
4790 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
4791 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
4792 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
4793 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
4794 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
4795 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
4796 // if it finds it.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004797 bool DivIsSigned = LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
4798 if (!I.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != I.isSignedPredicate())
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004799 break;
4800
4801 // Initialize the variables that will indicate the nature of the
4802 // range check.
4803 bool LoOverflow = false, HiOverflow = false;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004804 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
4805
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004806 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
4807 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
4808 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
4809 // instead of computing a divide.
4810 ConstantInt *Prod =
4811 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getMul(CI, DivRHS));
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004812
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004813 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
4814 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
4815 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
4816 bool ProdOV = !DivRHS->isNullValue() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004817 (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004818 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CI;
4819
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004820 // Get the ICmp opcode
4821 ICmpInst::Predicate predicate = I.getPredicate();
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00004822
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004823 if (DivRHS->isNullValue()) {
4824 // Don't hack on divide by zeros!
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004825 } else if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004826 LoBound = Prod;
4827 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
4828 HiOverflow = ProdOV || AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004829 } else if (isPositive(DivRHS)) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004830 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / pos) op 0
4831 // Can't overflow.
4832 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
4833 HiBound = DivRHS;
4834 } else if (isPositive(CI)) { // (X / pos) op pos
4835 LoBound = Prod;
4836 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
4837 HiOverflow = ProdOV || AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS);
4838 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
4839 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
4840 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
4841 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH));
4842 HiBound = Prod;
4843 HiOverflow = ProdOV;
4844 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004845 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004846 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / neg) op 0
4847 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
4848 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner73bcba52005-06-17 02:05:55 +00004849 if (HiBound == DivRHS)
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004850 LoBound = 0; // - INTMIN = INTMIN
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004851 } else if (isPositive(CI)) { // (X / neg) op pos
4852 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
4853 if (!LoOverflow)
4854 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS));
4855 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
4856 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
4857 LoBound = Prod;
4858 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
4859 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSub(Prod, DivRHS));
4860 }
Chris Lattner0b41e862004-10-08 19:15:44 +00004861
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00004862 // Dividing by a negate swaps the condition.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004863 predicate = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(predicate);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004864 }
4865
4866 if (LoBound) {
4867 Value *X = LHSI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004868 switch (predicate) {
4869 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
4870 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004871 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004872 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004873 else if (HiOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004874 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
4875 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004876 else if (LoOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004877 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
4878 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004879 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004880 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
4881 true, I);
4882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004883 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004885 else if (HiOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004886 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
4887 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004888 else if (LoOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004889 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
4890 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004891 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004892 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
4893 false, I);
4894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4895 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004896 if (LoOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004898 return new ICmpInst(predicate, X, LoBound);
4899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004901 if (HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004902 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004903 if (predicate == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
4904 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
4905 else
4906 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004907 }
4908 }
4909 }
4910 break;
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004911 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004912
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004913 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004914 if (I.isEquality()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004915 bool isICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00004916
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004917 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
4918 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004919 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
4920 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004921 case Instruction::SRem:
4922 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
4923 if (CI->isNullValue() && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&
4924 BO->hasOneUse()) {
4925 int64_t V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getSExtValue();
4926 if (V > 1 && isPowerOf2_64(V)) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00004927 Value *NewRem = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createURem(
4928 BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1), BO->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004929 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NewRem,
4930 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner23b47b62004-07-06 07:38:18 +00004931 }
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00004932 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004933 break;
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004934 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00004935 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
4936 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb121ae12004-09-21 21:35:23 +00004937 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004938 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
4939 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00004940 } else if (CI->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004941 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
4942 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
4943 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004944
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004945 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004946 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004947 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004948 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00004949 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004950 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1, BO->getName());
4951 BO->setName("");
4952 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004953 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004954 }
4955 }
4956 break;
4957 case Instruction::Xor:
4958 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
4959 // the explicit xor.
4960 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004961 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
4962 ConstantExpr::getXor(CI, BOC));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004963
4964 // FALLTHROUGH
4965 case Instruction::Sub:
4966 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
4967 if (CI->isNullValue())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004968 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
4969 BO->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004970 break;
4971
4972 case Instruction::Or:
4973 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
4974 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004975 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00004976 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(CI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004977 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004978 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4979 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004980 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004981 break;
4982
4983 case Instruction::And:
4984 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00004985 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
4986 // comparison can never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00004987 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(CI,
4988 ConstantExpr::getNot(BOC))->isNullValue())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004989 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4990 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004991
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00004992 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
Chris Lattneree59d4b2004-06-10 02:33:20 +00004993 if (CI == BOC && isOneBitSet(CI))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004994 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
4995 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,
4996 Constant::getNullValue(CI->getType()));
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00004997
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004998 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00004999 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5000 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005001 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5002 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5003 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5004 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005005 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005006
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00005007 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00005008 if (CI->isNullValue() && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5009 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00005010 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005011 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5012 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5013 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00005014 }
5015
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00005016 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005017 default: break;
5018 }
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005019 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Op0)) {
5020 // Handle set{eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5021 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
5022 default: break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005023 case Intrinsic::bswap_i16:
5024 // icmp eq (bswap(x)), c -> icmp eq (x,bswap(c))
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005025 WorkList.push_back(II); // Dead?
5026 I.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005027 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int16Ty,
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005028 ByteSwap_16(CI->getZExtValue())));
5029 return &I;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005030 case Intrinsic::bswap_i32:
5031 // icmp eq (bswap(x)), c -> icmp eq (x,bswap(c))
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005032 WorkList.push_back(II); // Dead?
5033 I.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005034 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005035 ByteSwap_32(CI->getZExtValue())));
5036 return &I;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005037 case Intrinsic::bswap_i64:
5038 // icmp eq (bswap(x)), c -> icmp eq (x,bswap(c))
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005039 WorkList.push_back(II); // Dead?
5040 I.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005041 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int64Ty,
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005042 ByteSwap_64(CI->getZExtValue())));
5043 return &I;
5044 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005045 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005046 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
5047 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size, then
5048 // since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005049 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5050 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5051 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005052 unsigned SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005053 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005054 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005055 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5056 // smaller constant values.
5057 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5058 default: break;
5059 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: { // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5060 ConstantInt *CUI = cast<ConstantInt>(CI);
5061 if (CUI->getZExtValue() == 1ULL << (SrcTySize-1))
5062 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5063 ConstantInt::get(SrcTy, -1));
5064 break;
5065 }
5066 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: { // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5067 ConstantInt *CUI = cast<ConstantInt>(CI);
5068 if (CUI->getZExtValue() == (1ULL << (SrcTySize-1))-1)
5069 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5070 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5071 break;
5072 }
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005073 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005074
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005075 }
5076 }
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00005077 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005078 }
5079
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005080 // Handle icmp with constant RHS
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005081 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5082 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5083 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005084 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5085 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005086 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005087 bool isAllZeros = true;
5088 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5089 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5090 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5091 isAllZeros = false;
5092 break;
5093 }
5094 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005095 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005096 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5097 }
5098 break;
5099
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005100 case Instruction::PHI:
5101 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5102 return NV;
5103 break;
5104 case Instruction::Select:
5105 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5106 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5107 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5108 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5109 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5110 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5111 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005112 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5113 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5114 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5115 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5116 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005117 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5118 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005119 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5120 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5121 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5122 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5123 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005124 }
5125 }
Jeff Cohen82639852005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005126
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005127 if (Op1)
5128 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
5129 break;
5130 }
5131 }
5132
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005133 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005134 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005135 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005136 return NI;
5137 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005138 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5139 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005140 return NI;
5141
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005142 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005143 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5144 // now.
5145 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5146 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5147 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005148 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5149 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005150 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005151
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005152 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5153 // so eliminate it as well.
5154 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5155 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005156
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005157 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005158 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005159 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005160 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005161 } else {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005162 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005163 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005164 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005165 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005166 }
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005167 }
5168
5169 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005170 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005171 // This comes up when you have code like
5172 // int X = A < B;
5173 // if (X) ...
5174 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005175 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5176 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005177 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005178 return R;
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005179 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005180
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005181 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005182 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5183 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5184 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5185 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5186 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5187 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5188 }
5189
5190 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5191 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5192 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5193 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5194 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
5195 Constant *NC = ConstantExpr::getXor(C1, C2);
5196 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5197 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5198 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5199 }
5200
5201 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5202 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5203 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5204 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5205 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5206 }
5207 }
5208
5209 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5210 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005211 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5212 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005213 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5214 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005215 }
5216 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005217 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005218 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5219 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005220 }
5221 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005222 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005223 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5224 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005225 }
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005226
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005227 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5228 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5229 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5230 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5231 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5232
5233 if (A == C) {
5234 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5235 } else if (A == D) {
5236 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5237 } else if (B == C) {
5238 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5239 } else if (B == D) {
5240 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5241 }
5242
5243 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5244 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5245 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5246 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5247 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5248 return &I;
5249 }
5250 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005251 }
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005252 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005253}
5254
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005255// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005256// We only handle extending casts so far.
5257//
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005258Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5259 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005260 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5261 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005262 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005263 Value *RHSCIOp;
5264
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005265 // We only handle extension cast instructions, so far. Enforce this.
5266 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5267 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattner03f06f12005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005268 return 0;
5269
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005270 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5271 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005272
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005273 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005274 // Not an extension from the same type?
5275 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005276 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5277 return 0;
Chris Lattner387bf3f2007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005278
5279 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5280 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5281 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5282 return 0;
5283
5284 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5285 // then we can't handle this.
5286 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5287 return 0;
5288
5289 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5290 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer279fa252004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005291 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005292
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005293 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5294 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5295 if (!CI)
5296 return 0;
5297
5298 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5299 // reextended to DestTy.
5300 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5301 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5302
5303 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5304 if (Res2 == CI) {
5305 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5306 // For example, we might have:
5307 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5308 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5309 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5310 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5311 // because %A may have negative value.
5312 //
5313 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5314 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005315 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005316 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5317 else
5318 return 0;
5319 }
5320
5321 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5322 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5323
5324 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5325 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5326 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005328 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005330
5331 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5332 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5333 Value *Result;
5334 if (isSignedCmp) {
5335 // We're performing a signed comparison.
5336 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getSExtValue() < 0)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005337 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005338 else
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005339 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005340 } else {
5341 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5342 if (isSignedExt) {
5343 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5344 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005345 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005346 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5347 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5348 } else {
5349 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005350 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005351 }
5352 }
5353
5354 // Finally, return the value computed.
5355 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5356 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5358 } else {
5359 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5360 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5361 "ICmp should be folded!");
5362 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5364 else
5365 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5366 }
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005367}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005368
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005369Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5370 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5371}
5372
5373Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5374 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5375}
5376
5377Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5378 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5379}
5380
5381Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5382 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005383 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005384
5385 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5386 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005387 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005388 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5389 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005390
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005391 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5392 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner67f05452004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005394 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5396 }
5397 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005398 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5400 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005401 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005402 }
5403
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005404 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5405 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005406 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005407 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005408 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5409
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005410 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5411 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5412 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005413 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005414 return R;
5415
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005416 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005417 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00005418 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5419 1ULL << (I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1))) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005420 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005421 }
5422 }
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005423
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005424 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005425 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5426 return Res;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005427 return 0;
5428}
5429
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005430Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005431 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005432 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005433
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005434 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5435 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
5436 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00005437 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitMask(),
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005438 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5439 return &I;
5440
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005441 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5442 // of a signed value.
5443 //
5444 unsigned TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005445 if (Op1->getZExtValue() >= TypeBits) {
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005446 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5448 else {
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005449 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005450 return &I;
Chris Lattnerf5ce2542004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005451 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005452 }
5453
5454 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5455 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5456 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5457 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5458 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5459 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5460
5461 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5462 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5463 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5464 return R;
5465 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5466 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5467 return NV;
5468
5469 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005470 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5471 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5472 Value *V1, *V2;
5473 ConstantInt *CC;
5474 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005475 default: break;
5476 case Instruction::Add:
5477 case Instruction::And:
5478 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005479 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005480 // These operators commute.
5481 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005482 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5483 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005484 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005485 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005486 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005487 Op0BO->getName());
5488 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005489 Instruction *X =
5490 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5491 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005492 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
5493 Constant *C2 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005494 C2 = ConstantExpr::getShl(C2, Op1);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005495 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, C2);
5496 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005497
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005498 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005499 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
5500 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() && V2 == Op1 &&
5501 match(Op0BOOp1,
5502 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
5503 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)-> hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005504 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005505 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5506 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005507 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5508 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005509 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005510 V1->getName()+".mask");
5511 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5512
5513 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5514 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005515 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005516
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005517 // FALL THROUGH.
5518 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005519 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005520 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5521 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005522 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005523 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005524 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5525 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005526 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005527 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005528 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005529 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005530 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
5531 Constant *C2 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005532 C2 = ConstantExpr::getShl(C2, Op1);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005533 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, C2);
5534 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005535
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005536 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005537 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5538 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5539 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005540 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005541 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
5542 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005543 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005544 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5545 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005546 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5547 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005548 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005549 V1->getName()+".mask");
5550 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5551
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005552 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005553 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005554
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005555 break;
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005556 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005557 }
5558
5559
5560 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
5561 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
5562 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
5563 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
5564 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
5565
5566 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005567 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner44bd3922004-10-08 03:46:20 +00005568 case Instruction::Add:
5569 isValid = isLeftShift;
5570 break;
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005571 case Instruction::Or:
5572 case Instruction::Xor:
5573 highBitSet = false;
5574 break;
5575 case Instruction::And:
5576 highBitSet = true;
5577 break;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005578 }
5579
5580 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
5581 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
5582 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
5583 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
5584 // operation.
5585 //
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005586 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005587 uint64_t Val = Op0C->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005588 isValid = ((Val & (1 << (TypeBits-1))) != 0) == highBitSet;
5589 }
5590
5591 if (isValid) {
5592 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
5593
5594 Instruction *NewShift =
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005595 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5596 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005597 Op0BO->setName("");
5598 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
5599
5600 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
5601 NewRHS);
5602 }
5603 }
5604 }
5605 }
5606
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005607 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005608 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5609 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
5610 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005611
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005612 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005613 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005614 unsigned ShiftAmt1 = (unsigned)ShiftAmt1C->getZExtValue();
5615 unsigned ShiftAmt2 = (unsigned)Op1->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005616 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
5617 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
5618 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005619
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005620 unsigned AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
5621 if (AmtSum > I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
5622 AmtSum = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5623
5624 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
5625
5626 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner6c344e52007-02-03 23:28:07 +00005627 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005628 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
5629 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5630 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
5631 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
5632 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
5633 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5634 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
5635 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5636 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
5637 Instruction *Shift =
5638 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5639 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5640
5641 uint64_t Mask = Ty->getBitMask() >> ShiftAmt2;
5642 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Ty, Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005643 }
5644
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005645 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
5646 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
5647 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
5648 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
5649 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Chris Lattner0a28e902007-02-05 04:09:35 +00005650 uint64_t Mask = Ty->getBitMask() << ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005651 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, Mask));
5652 }
5653 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
5654 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattner0a28e902007-02-05 04:09:35 +00005655 uint64_t Mask = Ty->getBitMask() >> ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005656 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, Mask));
5657 }
5658 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
5659 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
5660 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
5661 // generators.
5662 const Type *SExtType = 0;
5663 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
5664 case 8 : SExtType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
5665 case 16: SExtType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
5666 case 32: SExtType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
5667 default: break;
5668 }
5669 if (SExtType) {
5670 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
5671 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
5672 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
5673 }
5674 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
5675 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
5676 unsigned ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005677
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005678 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005679 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5680 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5681 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005682 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005683 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005684 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5685
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005686 uint64_t Mask = Ty->getBitMask() << ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005687 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Ty, Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005688 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005689
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005690 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005691 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5692 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5693 Instruction *Shift =
5694 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5695 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005696
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005697 uint64_t Mask = Ty->getBitMask() >> ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005698 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Ty, Mask));
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005699 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005700
5701 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
5702 } else {
5703 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
5704 unsigned ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
5705
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005706 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005707 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5708 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5709 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
5710 Instruction *Shift =
5711 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
5712 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5713 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5714
5715 uint64_t Mask = Ty->getBitMask() << ShiftAmt2;
5716 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Ty, Mask));
5717 }
5718
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005719 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005720 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5721 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5722 Instruction *Shift =
5723 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5724 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5725
5726 uint64_t Mask = Ty->getBitMask() >> ShiftAmt2;
5727 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Ty, Mask));
5728 }
5729
5730 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005731 }
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005732 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005733 return 0;
5734}
5735
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00005736
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005737/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
5738/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
5739/// X*Scale+Offset.
5740///
5741static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
5742 unsigned &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005743 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005744 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005745 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
5746 Scale = 1;
5747 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005748 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
5749 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005750 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005751 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5752 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
5753 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
5754 Offset = 0;
5755 return I->getOperand(0);
5756 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
5757 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
5758 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
5759 Offset = 0;
5760 return I->getOperand(0);
5761 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
5762 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
5763 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
5764 unsigned SubScale;
5765 Value *SubVal =
5766 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
5767 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
5768 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
5769 Scale = SubScale;
5770 return SubVal;
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005771 }
5772 }
5773 }
5774 }
5775 }
5776
5777 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
5778 Scale = 1;
5779 Offset = 0;
5780 return Val;
5781}
5782
5783
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005784/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
5785/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
5786Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI,
5787 AllocationInst &AI) {
5788 const PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005789 if (!PTy) return 0; // Not casting the allocation to a pointer type.
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005790
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005791 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
5792 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
5793 std::vector<Instruction*> DeadUsers;
5794 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
5795 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
5796 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
5797 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
5798 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
5799
5800 // Add operands to the worklist.
5801 AddUsesToWorkList(*User);
5802 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00005803 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005804
5805 User->eraseFromParent();
5806 removeFromWorkList(User);
5807 }
5808 }
5809
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005810 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
5811 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
5812 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
5813 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005814
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00005815 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getTypeAlignmentABI(AllocElTy);
5816 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getTypeAlignmentABI(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005817 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
5818
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00005819 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
5820 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
5821 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
5822 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
5823
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005824 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
5825 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005826 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005827
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005828 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
5829 // size argument.
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005830 unsigned ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset;
5831 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
5832 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
5833
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005834 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
5835 // do the xform.
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005836 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
5837 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00005838
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005839 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
5840 Value *Amt = 0;
5841 if (Scale == 1) {
5842 Amt = NumElements;
5843 } else {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005844 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005845 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
5846 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005847 Amt = ConstantExpr::getMul(
5848 cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
5849 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005850 else if (Scale != 1) {
5851 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
5852 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00005853 }
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005854 }
5855
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005856 if (unsigned Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005857 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005858 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
5859 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
5860 }
5861
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005862 std::string Name = AI.getName(); AI.setName("");
5863 AllocationInst *New;
5864 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00005865 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment(), Name);
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005866 else
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00005867 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment(), Name);
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005868 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00005869
5870 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
5871 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
5872 // die soon.
5873 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
5874 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005875 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
5876 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
5877 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00005878 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
5879 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
5880 }
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005881 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
5882}
5883
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005884/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
5885/// and return it without inserting any new casts. This is used by code that
5886/// tries to decide whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider
5887/// or smaller types will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
5888static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
5889 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
5890 if (isa<Constant>(V)) return true;
5891
5892 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
5893 if (!I || !I->hasOneUse()) return false;
5894
5895 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
5896 case Instruction::And:
5897 case Instruction::Or:
5898 case Instruction::Xor:
5899 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
5900 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved) &&
5901 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00005902 case Instruction::AShr:
5903 case Instruction::LShr:
5904 case Instruction::Shl:
5905 // If this is just a bitcast changing the sign of the operation, we can
5906 // convert if the operand can be converted.
5907 if (V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() == Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
5908 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
5909 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005910 case Instruction::Trunc:
5911 case Instruction::ZExt:
5912 case Instruction::SExt:
5913 case Instruction::BitCast:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005914 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
5915 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
5916 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00005917 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
5918 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
5919 // casts first.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00005920 if (isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00005921 return true;
5922
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005923 ++NumCastsRemoved;
5924 return true;
5925 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005926 break;
5927 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005928 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
5929 break;
5930 }
5931
5932 return false;
5933}
5934
5935/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
5936/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
5937/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00005938Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
5939 bool isSigned ) {
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005940 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00005941 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005942
5943 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
5944 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerd0622b62006-05-20 23:14:03 +00005945 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005946 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
5947 case Instruction::And:
5948 case Instruction::Or:
5949 case Instruction::Xor: {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00005950 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
5951 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005952 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
5953 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
5954 break;
5955 }
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00005956 case Instruction::AShr:
5957 case Instruction::LShr:
5958 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00005959 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005960 Res = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::BinaryOps(I->getOpcode()), LHS,
5961 I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00005962 break;
5963 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005964 case Instruction::Trunc:
5965 case Instruction::ZExt:
5966 case Instruction::SExt:
5967 case Instruction::BitCast:
5968 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
5969 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because its not new.
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005970 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
5971 return I->getOperand(0);
5972
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005973 // Some other kind of cast, which shouldn't happen, so just ..
5974 // FALL THROUGH
5975 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00005976 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
5977 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
5978 break;
5979 }
5980
5981 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
5982}
5983
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005984/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
5985Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00005986 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
5987
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005988 // Casting undef to anything results in undef so might as just replace it and
5989 // get rid of the cast.
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005990 if (isa<UndefValue>(Src)) // cast undef -> undef
5991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(CI.getType()));
5992
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005993 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If its eliminable we just
5994 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005995 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005996 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
5997 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
5998 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
5999 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6000 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006001 }
6002 }
Chris Lattner03841652004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006003
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006004 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6005 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
6006 //
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006007 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006008 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
6009 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6010 if (!isa<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i)) ||
6011 !cast<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6012 AllZeroOperands = false;
6013 break;
6014 }
6015 if (AllZeroOperands) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006016 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6017 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6018 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006019 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6020 return &CI;
6021 }
6022 }
Chris Lattnerec45a4c2006-11-21 17:05:13 +00006023
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006024 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
6025 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006026 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006027 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
6028 return V;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006029
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006030 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006031 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6032 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6033 return NV;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006034
6035 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006036 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6037 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6038 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006039
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006040 return 0;
6041}
6042
6043/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCONVERT can have both operands as
6044/// integers. This function implements the common transforms for all those
6045/// cases.
6046/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6047Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6048 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6049 return Result;
6050
6051 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6052 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6053 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
6054 unsigned SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6055 unsigned DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6056
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006057 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6058 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
6059 uint64_t KnownZero = 0, KnownOne = 0;
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00006060 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitMask(),
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006061 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6062 return &CI;
6063
6064 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6065 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006066 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6067 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006068 return 0;
6069
6070 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006071 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
6072 if (CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, NumCastsRemoved)) {
6073 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
6074 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a noop-cast
6075 // this just removes a noop cast which isn't pointful, but simplifies
6076 // the code. If this is a zero-extension, we need to do an AND to
6077 // maintain the clear top-part of the computation, so we require that
6078 // the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this is a sign
6079 // extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
6080 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
6081 bool DoXForm = CI.isNoopCast(TD->getIntPtrType());
6082 if (!DoXForm) {
6083 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6084 case Instruction::Trunc:
6085 DoXForm = true;
6086 break;
6087 case Instruction::ZExt:
6088 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6089 break;
6090 case Instruction::SExt:
6091 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6092 break;
6093 case Instruction::BitCast:
6094 DoXForm = false;
6095 break;
6096 default:
6097 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6098 // get here because of the check above.
6099 assert(!"Unknown cast type .. unreachable");
6100 break;
6101 }
6102 }
6103
6104 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006105 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6106 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006107 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6108 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6109 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6110 case Instruction::Trunc:
6111 case Instruction::BitCast:
6112 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6113 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6114 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6115 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6116 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
6117 Constant *C =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006118 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int64Ty, (1ULL << SrcBitSize)-1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006119 if (DestBitSize < 64)
6120 C = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, DestTy);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006121 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6122 }
6123 case Instruction::SExt:
6124 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6125 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006126 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6127 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006128 }
6129 }
6130 }
6131
6132 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6133 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6134
6135 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6136 case Instruction::Add:
6137 case Instruction::Mul:
6138 case Instruction::And:
6139 case Instruction::Or:
6140 case Instruction::Xor:
6141 // If we are discarding information, or just changing the sign,
6142 // rewrite.
6143 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6144 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6145 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6146 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6147 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006148 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6149 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006150 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006151 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6152 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6153 return BinaryOperator::create(
6154 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006155 }
6156 }
6157
6158 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6159 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6160 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006161 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006162 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006163 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006164 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6165 }
6166 break;
6167 case Instruction::SDiv:
6168 case Instruction::UDiv:
6169 case Instruction::SRem:
6170 case Instruction::URem:
6171 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6172 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6173 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6174 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6175 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006176 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6177 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006178 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6179 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6180 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6181 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006182 return BinaryOperator::create(
6183 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6184 }
6185 }
6186 break;
6187
6188 case Instruction::Shl:
6189 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6190 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6191 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6192 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6193 // in the value.
6194 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6195 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006196 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6197 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6198 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006199 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006200 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006201 }
6202 break;
6203 case Instruction::AShr:
6204 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6205 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6206 // simplifications.
6207 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6208 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6209 unsigned ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getZExtValue();
6210 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6211 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006212 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006213 }
6214 }
6215 break;
6216
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006217 case Instruction::ICmp:
6218 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and casting it
6219 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006220 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6221 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6222 uint64_t Op1CV = Op1C->getZExtValue();
6223 // cast (X == 0) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6224 // cast (X == 0) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6225 // cast (X == 1) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6226 // cast (X == 2) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6227 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6228 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6229 // cast (X != 1) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6230 // cast (X != 2) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6231 if (Op1CV == 0 || isPowerOf2_64(Op1CV)) {
6232 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
6233 uint64_t KnownZero, KnownOne;
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00006234 uint64_t TypeMask = Op1C->getType()->getBitMask();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006235 ComputeMaskedBits(Op0, TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006236
6237 // This only works for EQ and NE
6238 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI)->getPredicate();
6239 if (pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6240 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006241
6242 if (isPowerOf2_64(KnownZero^TypeMask)) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006243 bool isNE = pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006244 if (Op1CV && (Op1CV != (KnownZero^TypeMask))) {
6245 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6246 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006247 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006248 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6250 }
6251
6252 unsigned ShiftAmt = Log2_64(KnownZero^TypeMask);
6253 Value *In = Op0;
6254 if (ShiftAmt) {
6255 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6256 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6257 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006258 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006259 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6260 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006261 }
6262
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006263 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006264 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6265 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6266 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6267 }
6268
6269 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6271 else
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006272 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006273 }
6274 }
6275 }
6276 break;
6277 }
6278 return 0;
6279}
6280
6281Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006282 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6283 return Result;
6284
6285 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6286 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
6287 unsigned DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6288
6289 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6290 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6291 default: break;
6292 case Instruction::LShr:
6293 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6294 // are already zeros.
6295 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
6296 unsigned ShAmt = ShAmtV->getZExtValue();
6297
6298 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
6299 uint64_t Mask = (~0ULL >> (64-ShAmt)) << DestBitWidth;
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006300 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6301 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006302 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6304
6305 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6306 // shift.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006307 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6308 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6309 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006310 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006311 }
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006312 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6313
6314 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6315 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6316 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006317 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006318 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6319
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006320 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006321 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006322 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006323 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6324 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6325 "tmp"), CI);
6326 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006327 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006328 }
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006329 }
6330 break;
6331 }
6332 }
6333
6334 return 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006335}
6336
6337Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(CastInst &CI) {
6338 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6339 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6340 return Result;
6341
6342 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6343
6344 // If this is a cast of a cast
6345 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006346 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6347 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6348 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6349 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6350 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6351 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
6352 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6353 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6354 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6355 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6356 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6357 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Reid Spencera94d3942007-01-19 21:13:56 +00006358 uint64_t AndValue = cast<IntegerType>(CSrc->getType())->getBitMask();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006359 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(A->getType(), AndValue);
6360 Instruction *And =
6361 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6362 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6363 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6364 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6365 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006366 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006367 }
6368 return And;
6369 }
6370 }
6371 }
6372
6373 return 0;
6374}
6375
6376Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(CastInst &CI) {
6377 return commonIntCastTransforms(CI);
6378}
6379
6380Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
6381 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6382}
6383
6384Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
6385 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6386}
6387
6388Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006389 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006390}
6391
6392Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006393 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006394}
6395
6396Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6397 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6398}
6399
6400Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6401 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6402}
6403
6404Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006405 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006406}
6407
6408Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
6409 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6410}
6411
6412Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(CastInst &CI) {
6413
6414 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
6415 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
6416 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6417 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6418 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
6419
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00006420 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006421 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6422 return Result;
6423 } else {
6424 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6425 return Result;
6426 }
6427
6428
6429 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
6430 // be replaced by the operand.
6431 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
6432 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
6433
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006434 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent to
6435 // a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate getelementptr.
6436 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006437 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
6438 if (const PointerType *SrcPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
6439 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
6440 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006441
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006442 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006443 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006444 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
6445 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
6446 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
6447 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006448 ++NumZeros;
6449 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006450
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006451 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006452 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
Chris Lattner416a8932007-01-31 20:08:52 +00006453 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
6454 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, &Idxs[0], Idxs.size());
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006455 }
6456 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006457 }
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00006458
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006459 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
6460 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
6461 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
6462 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
6463 if (isa<PackedType>(DestTy) &&
6464 cast<PackedType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
6465 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
6466 CastInst *Tmp;
6467 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
6468 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
6469 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
6470 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
6471 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
6472 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
6473 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006474 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6475 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
6476 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6477 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006478 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
6479 // know the vector types match #elts.
6480 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +00006481 }
6482 }
6483 }
6484 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00006485 return 0;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00006486}
6487
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006488/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
6489/// %C = or %A, %B
6490/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
6491/// into:
6492/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
6493/// %D = or %A, %C
6494///
6495/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
6496/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
6497/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
6498///
6499static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
6500 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6501 case Instruction::Add:
6502 case Instruction::Mul:
6503 case Instruction::And:
6504 case Instruction::Or:
6505 case Instruction::Xor:
6506 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
6507 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
6508 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006509 case Instruction::LShr:
6510 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006511 return 1;
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006512 default:
6513 return 0; // Cannot fold
6514 }
6515}
6516
6517/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
6518/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
6519static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
6520 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6521 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
6522 case Instruction::Add:
6523 case Instruction::Sub:
6524 case Instruction::Or:
6525 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006526 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006527 case Instruction::LShr:
6528 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006529 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006530 case Instruction::And:
6531 return ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
6532 case Instruction::Mul:
6533 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
6534 }
6535}
6536
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006537/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
6538/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
6539Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
6540 Instruction *FI) {
6541 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
6542 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
6543 // merge.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006544 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006545 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
6546 return 0;
6547 } else {
6548 return 0; // unknown unary op.
6549 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006550
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006551 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
6552 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
6553 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
6554 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006555 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
6556 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006557 }
6558
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006559 // Only handle binary operators here.
6560 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006561 return 0;
6562
6563 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
6564 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
6565 bool MatchIsOpZero;
6566 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6567 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6568 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6569 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6570 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6571 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6572 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6573 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6574 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6575 MatchIsOpZero = false;
6576 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
6577 return 0;
6578 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6579 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6580 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6581 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6582 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6583 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6584 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6585 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6586 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6587 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6588 } else {
6589 return 0;
6590 }
6591
6592 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
6593 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
6594 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
6595 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
6596
6597 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
6598 if (MatchIsOpZero)
6599 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
6600 else
6601 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006602 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006603 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
6604 return 0;
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006605}
6606
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00006607Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006608 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
6609 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
6610 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
6611
6612 // select true, X, Y -> X
6613 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006614 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006615 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006616
6617 // select C, X, X -> X
6618 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
6619 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6620
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006621 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
6622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6623 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
6624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6625 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
6626 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
6627 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6628 else
6629 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6630 }
6631
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006632 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006633 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006634 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006635 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006636 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006637 } else {
6638 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
6639 Value *NotCond =
6640 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6641 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006642 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006643 }
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006644 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006645 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006646 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006647 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006648 } else {
6649 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
6650 Value *NotCond =
6651 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6652 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006653 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006654 }
6655 }
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006656 }
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006657
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006658 // Selecting between two integer constants?
6659 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
6660 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
6661 // select C, 1, 0 -> cast C to int
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006662 if (FalseValC->isNullValue() && TrueValC->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006663 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006664 } else if (TrueValC->isNullValue() && FalseValC->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006665 // select C, 0, 1 -> cast !C to int
6666 Value *NotCond =
6667 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006668 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006669 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006670 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006671
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006672 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006673
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006674 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
6675 // (x >u 2147483647) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006676 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isNullValue())
6677 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
6678 bool CanXForm = false;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006679 if (IC->isSignedPredicate())
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006680 CanXForm = CmpCst->isNullValue() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006681 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006682 else {
6683 unsigned Bits = CmpCst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006684 CanXForm = (CmpCst->getZExtValue() == ~0ULL >> (64-Bits+1)) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006685 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006686 }
6687
6688 if (CanXForm) {
6689 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006690 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006691 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006692 unsigned Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006693 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
6694 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
6695 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006696 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
6697
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006698 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
6699 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
6700 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
6701 unsigned SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6702 unsigned SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6703 if (SRASize < SISize)
6704 opc = Instruction::SExt;
6705 else if (SRASize > SISize)
6706 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
6707 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006708 }
6709 }
6710
6711
6712 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006713 // have a fcmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006714 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
6715 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
6716 if (TrueValC->isNullValue() || FalseValC->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006717 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006718 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
6719 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
6720 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006721 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
6722 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
6723 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006724 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
6725 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006726 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
6727 // true or false val is the zero.
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006728 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isNullValue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006729 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006730 Value *V = ICA;
6731 if (ShouldNotVal)
6732 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
6733 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
6734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
6735 }
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006736 }
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006737 }
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006738
6739 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006740 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
6741 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006742 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006743 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6745 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006746 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6748 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6749
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006750 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006751 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006752 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00006753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006754 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006755 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
6756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6757 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6758 }
6759 }
6760
6761 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
6762 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
6763 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
6764 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
6765 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6766 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6767 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
6768 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6770 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6771
6772 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
6773 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
6774 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6775 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6776 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
6777 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00006778 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006779 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6780 }
6781 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006782
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006783 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
6784 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
6785 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006786 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
6787
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006788 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
6789 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
6790 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
6791 return IV;
6792
6793 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
6794 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006795 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
6796 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6797 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
6798 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
6799 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6800 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
6801 }
6802
6803 if (AddOp) {
6804 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
6805 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
6806 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
6807 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
6808 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
6809 }
6810
6811 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00006812 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
6813 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
6814 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
6815 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
6816 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
6817 } else {
6818 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
6819 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006820 }
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00006821
6822 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
6823 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
6824 if (AddOp != TI)
6825 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
6826 Instruction *NewSel =
6827 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
6828
6829 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
6830 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006831 }
6832 }
6833 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006834
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006835 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00006836 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006837 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
6838 // transformation we are doing here.
6839 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
6840 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
6841 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
6842 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
6843 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
6844 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
6845 OpToFold = 1;
6846 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
6847 OpToFold = 2;
6848 }
6849
6850 if (OpToFold) {
6851 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
6852 std::string Name = TVI->getName(); TVI->setName("");
6853 Instruction *NewSel =
6854 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C,
6855 Name);
6856 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
6857 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
6858 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006859 else {
6860 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
6861 }
6862 }
6863 }
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00006864
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006865 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
6866 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
6867 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
6868 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
6869 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
6870 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
6871 OpToFold = 1;
6872 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
6873 OpToFold = 2;
6874 }
6875
6876 if (OpToFold) {
6877 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006878 std::string Name = FVI->getName();
6879 FVI->setName("");
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006880 Instruction *NewSel =
6881 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold),
6882 Name);
6883 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
6884 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
6885 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006886 else
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006887 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006888 }
6889 }
6890 }
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00006891
6892 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
6893 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
6894 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
6895 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
6896 return &SI;
6897 }
6898
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00006899 return 0;
6900}
6901
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006902/// GetKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that we can
6903/// determine, return it, otherwise return 0.
6904static unsigned GetKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD) {
6905 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
6906 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
6907 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00006908 Align = TD->getTypeAlignmentPref(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006909 return Align;
6910 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
6911 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
6912 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
6913 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00006914 Align = TD->getTypeAlignmentPref(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006915 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
6916 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00006917 Align = TD->getTypeAlignmentABI(AI->getType()->getElementType());
6918 Align =
6919 std::max(Align,
6920 (unsigned)TD->getTypeAlignmentABI(Type::DoubleTy));
6921 Align =
6922 std::max(Align,
6923 (unsigned)TD->getTypeAlignmentABI(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006924 }
6925 }
6926 return Align;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006927 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00006928 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006929 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00006930 User *CI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006931 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
6932 return GetKnownAlignment(CI->getOperand(0), TD);
6933 return 0;
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00006934 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V) ||
6935 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
6936 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode()==Instruction::GetElementPtr)) {
6937 User *GEPI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006938 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD);
6939 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
6940
6941 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
6942 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
6943 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6944 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
6945 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6946 AllZeroOperands = false;
6947 break;
6948 }
6949 if (AllZeroOperands)
6950 return BaseAlignment;
6951
6952 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
6953 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
6954 // least as much as its type requires.
6955 if (!TD) return 0;
6956
6957 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00006958 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
6959 if (TD->getTypeAlignmentABI(PtrTy->getElementType())
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00006960 <= BaseAlignment) {
6961 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00006962 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
6963 return TD->getTypeAlignmentABI(GEPPtrTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00006964 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006965 return 0;
6966 }
6967 return 0;
6968}
6969
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00006970
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00006971/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
6972/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
6973/// the heavy lifting.
6974///
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00006975Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00006976 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
6977 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
6978
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00006979 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
6980 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00006981 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00006982 bool Changed = false;
6983
6984 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
6985 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
6986 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
6987
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00006988 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006989 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00006990 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
6991 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
6992 // alignment is sufficient.
6993 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00006994 }
6995
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00006996 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
6997 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
6998 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00006999 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007000 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7001 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7002 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007003 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth0ebb0b02006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007004 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007005 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007006 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7007 else
7008 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattnerfbc524f2007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007009 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007010 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7011 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7012 Changed = true;
7013 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007014 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007015
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007016 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7017 // set, update the alignment.
7018 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
7019 unsigned Alignment1 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7020 unsigned Alignment2 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
7021 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007022 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007023 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007024 Changed = true;
7025 }
7026 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
7027 unsigned Alignment = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007028 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007029 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007030 Changed = true;
7031 }
7032 }
7033
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007034 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007035 } else {
7036 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7037 default: break;
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007038 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7039 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007040 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7041 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7042 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7043 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7044 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007045 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007046 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007047 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007048 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7049 }
7050 break;
7051 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7052 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7053 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7054 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007055 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007056 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7057 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007058 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7059 }
7060 break;
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007061 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7062 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7063 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7064 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7065 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7066 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
7067 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007068 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7069 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007070 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7071 }
7072 break;
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007073
7074 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7075 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7076 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7077 uint64_t UndefElts;
7078 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7079 UndefElts)) {
7080 II->setOperand(1, V);
7081 return II;
7082 }
7083 break;
7084 }
7085
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007086 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7087 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
7088 if (ConstantPacked *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantPacked>(II->getOperand(3))) {
7089 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7090
7091 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7092 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7093 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7094 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7095 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7096 AllEltsOk = false;
7097 break;
7098 }
7099 }
7100
7101 if (AllEltsOk) {
7102 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007103 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7104 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7105 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7106 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007107 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7108
7109 // Only extract each element once.
7110 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7111 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7112
7113 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7114 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7115 continue;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007116 unsigned Idx =cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007117 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7118
7119 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7120 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007121 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007122 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7123 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7124 }
7125
7126 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007127 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007128 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7129 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007130 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007131 }
7132 }
7133 break;
7134
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007135 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7136 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7137 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7138 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7139 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7140 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7141 if (&*++BI == II)
7142 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7143 }
7144 }
7145
7146 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7147 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7148 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7149 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7150 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7151 bool CannotRemove = false;
7152 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7153 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7154 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7155 CannotRemove = true;
7156 break;
7157 }
7158 }
7159 if (!CannotRemove)
7160 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7161 }
7162 break;
7163 }
7164 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007165 }
7166
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007167 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007168}
7169
7170// InvokeInst simplification
7171//
7172Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007173 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007174}
7175
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007176// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7177//
7178Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007179 bool Changed = false;
7180
7181 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7182 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007183 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7184
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007185 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007186
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007187 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7188 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7189 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7190 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7191 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007192 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007193 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007194 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7195 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7196 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7197 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7198 return 0;
7199 }
7200
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007201 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7202 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7203 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7204 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007205 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007206 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007207 CS.getInstruction());
7208
7209 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7210 CS.getInstruction()->
7211 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7212
7213 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7214 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7215 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007216 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007217 }
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007218 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7219 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007220
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007221 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7222 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7223 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7224 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7225 // the call.
7226 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7227 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7228 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7229 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7230 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7231 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007232 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007233 *I = Op;
7234 Changed = true;
7235 }
7236 }
7237 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007238
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007239 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007240}
7241
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007242// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7243// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7244//
7245bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7246 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7247 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007248 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7249 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007250 return false;
Reid Spencer87436872004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007251 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007252 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7253
7254 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7255 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7256 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7257 //
7258 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7259 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7260
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007261 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7262 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007263 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007264 OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType() &&
7265 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7266 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7267 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007268 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007269
7270 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
7271 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
7272 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
7273 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
7274 if (!Caller->use_empty())
7275 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
7276 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
7277 UI != E; ++UI)
7278 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
7279 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007280 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007281 return false;
7282 }
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007283
7284 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
7285 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007286
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007287 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
7288 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
7289 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007290 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007291 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007292 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007293 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007294 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007295 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007296 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
7297 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
7298 && c->getSExtValue() > 0);
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007299 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007300 }
7301
7302 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007303 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007304 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
7305
7306 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
7307 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
7308 std::vector<Value*> Args;
7309 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
7310
7311 AI = CS.arg_begin();
7312 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7313 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
7314 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
7315 Args.push_back(*AI);
7316 } else {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007317 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007318 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007319 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007320 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007321 }
7322 }
7323
7324 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
7325 // now...
7326 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
7327 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
7328
7329 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
7330 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
7331 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlingf3baad32006-12-07 01:30:32 +00007332 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
7333 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007334 } else {
7335 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
7336 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7337 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
7338 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
7339 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007340 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
7341 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007342 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007343 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
7344 Args.push_back(Cast);
7345 } else {
7346 Args.push_back(*AI);
7347 }
7348 }
7349 }
7350
7351 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
7352 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name...
7353
7354 Instruction *NC;
7355 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007356 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007357 Args, Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007358 cast<InvokeInst>(II)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007359 } else {
7360 NC = new CallInst(Callee, Args, Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner6aacb0f2005-05-06 06:48:21 +00007361 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
7362 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007363 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007364 }
7365
7366 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary...
7367 Value *NV = NC;
7368 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
7369 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007370 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007371 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
7372 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007373 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner686767f2003-10-30 00:46:41 +00007374
7375 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
7376 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
7377 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
7378 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
7379 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
7380 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
7381 } else {
7382 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
7383 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
7384 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007385 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007386 } else {
Chris Lattnere29d6342004-10-17 21:22:38 +00007387 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007388 }
7389 }
7390
7391 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
7392 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
7393 Caller->getParent()->getInstList().erase(Caller);
7394 removeFromWorkList(Caller);
7395 return true;
7396}
7397
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007398/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
7399/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
7400/// and a single binop.
7401Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7402 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007403 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
7404 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007405 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007406 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7407 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
7408
7409 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
7410 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007411
7412 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
7413 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007414 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007415 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007416 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007417 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007418 // types or GEP's with different index types.
7419 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
7420 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007421 return 0;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007422
7423 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
7424 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
7425 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
7426 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
7427 return 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007428
7429 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
7430 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
7431 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007432 }
7433
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007434 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
7435
7436 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
7437 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
7438 // hide them behind a phi.
7439 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
7440 return 0;
7441
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007442 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007443 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007444 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007445 if (LHSVal == 0) {
7446 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
7447 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7448 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007449 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
7450 LHSVal = NewLHS;
7451 }
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007452
7453 if (RHSVal == 0) {
7454 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
7455 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7456 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007457 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
7458 RHSVal = NewRHS;
7459 }
7460
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007461 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
7462 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7463 if (NewLHS) {
7464 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7465 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7466 }
7467 if (NewRHS) {
7468 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
7469 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7470 }
7471 }
7472
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007473 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007474 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007475 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7476 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
7477 RHSVal);
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007478 else {
7479 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
7480 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
7481 }
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007482}
7483
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007484/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
7485/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
7486/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
7487/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007488///
7489/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
7490/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
7491/// to a register.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007492static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
7493 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
7494
7495 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
7496 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
7497 return false;
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007498
7499 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
7500 // profitable to do this xform.
7501 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
7502 bool isAddressTaken = false;
7503 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
7504 UI != E; ++UI) {
7505 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
7506 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
7507 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
7508 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
7509 }
7510 isAddressTaken = true;
7511 break;
7512 }
7513
7514 if (!isAddressTaken)
7515 return false;
7516 }
7517
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007518 return true;
7519}
7520
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007521
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007522// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
7523// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
7524// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
7525Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7526 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
7527
7528 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
7529 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
7530 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
7531 // code size and simplifying code.
7532 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
7533 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007534 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007535 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
7536 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007537 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007538 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
7539 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007540 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007541 if (ConstantOp == 0)
7542 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007543 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
7544 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
7545 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
7546 // load and the PHI.
7547 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
7548 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7549 return 0;
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007550 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007551 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007552 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
7553 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
7554 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007555 } else {
7556 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
7557 }
7558
7559 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
7560 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7561 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
7562 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007563 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007564 return 0;
7565 if (CastSrcTy) {
7566 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
7567 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007568 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007569 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
7570 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007571 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
7572 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
7573 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7574 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007575 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
7576 return 0;
7577 }
7578 }
7579
7580 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
7581 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
7582 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
7583 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00007584 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007585
7586 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7587 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007588
7589 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007590 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7591 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7592 if (NewInVal != InVal)
7593 InVal = 0;
7594 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7595 }
7596
7597 Value *PhiVal;
7598 if (InVal) {
7599 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
7600 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
7601 PhiVal = InVal;
7602 delete NewPN;
7603 } else {
7604 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
7605 PhiVal = NewPN;
7606 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007607
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007608 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007609 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
7610 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00007611 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007612 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007613 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007614 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007615 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7616 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
7617 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007618 else
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007619 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007620}
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007621
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007622/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
7623/// that is dead.
7624static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN, std::set<PHINode*> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
7625 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
7626 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
7627
7628 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
7629 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN).second)
7630 return true;
7631
7632 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
7633 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007634
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007635 return false;
7636}
7637
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007638// PHINode simplification
7639//
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007640Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonbbf89902006-07-10 22:15:25 +00007641 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
7642 if (mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID)) return 0;
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +00007643
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007644 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
7645 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
7646
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007647 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
7648 // reducing code size.
7649 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
7650 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
7651 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
7652 return Result;
7653
7654 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
7655 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
7656 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007657 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
7658 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
7659 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007660 std::set<PHINode*> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
7661 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
7662 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
7663 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7664 }
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007665
7666 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
7667 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
7668 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
7669 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
7670 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
7671 // late.
7672 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
7673 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
7674 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
7675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7676 }
7677 }
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007678
Chris Lattner91daeb52003-12-19 05:58:40 +00007679 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007680}
7681
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007682static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
7683 Instruction *InsertPoint,
7684 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007685 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7686 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007687 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
7688 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
7689 // used for address computation.
7690 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
7691 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
7692 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
7693 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007694}
7695
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007696
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007697Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007698 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner471bd762003-05-22 19:07:21 +00007699 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, long 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007700 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007701 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007702 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007703
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007704 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
7705 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
7706
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007707 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
7708 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
7709 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
7710
7711 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007713
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007714 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
7715 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007716 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
7717 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI)
7718 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
7719 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00007720 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
7721 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
7722 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
7723 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
7724 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
7725 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
7726 MadeChange = true;
7727 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007728 }
7729 }
7730 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007731 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
7732 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
7733 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
7734 // obvious.
7735 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007736 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00007737 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007738 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00007739 MadeChange = true;
7740 } else {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007741 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
7742 GEP);
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007743 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
7744 MadeChange = true;
7745 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007746 }
7747 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
7748
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007749 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
7750 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
7751 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
7752 //
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00007753 std::vector<Value*> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00007754 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00007755 SrcGEPOperands.assign(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00007756
7757 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007758 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
7759 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
7760 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
7761 //
7762 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
7763 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
7764 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
7765
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007766 std::vector<Value *> Indices;
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007767
7768 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
7769 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
7770 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
7771 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattner8ec5f882004-05-08 22:41:42 +00007772 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007773
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007774 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007775 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattner235af562003-03-05 22:33:14 +00007776 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
7777 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
7778 //
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007779 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007780 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
7781 Sum = GO1;
7782 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
7783 Sum = SO1;
7784 } else {
7785 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
7786 // target's pointer size.
7787 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
7788 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007789 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007790 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007791 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007792 } else {
7793 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007794 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007795 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007796 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007797
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007798 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007799 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007800 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007801 } else {
7802 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007803 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
7804 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007805 }
7806 }
7807 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007808 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
7809 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
7810 else {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007811 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
7812 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007813 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007814 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007815
7816 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
7817 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
7818 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
7819 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
7820 return &GEP;
7821 } else {
7822 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
7823 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
7824 Indices.push_back(Sum);
7825 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
7826 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007827 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007828 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007829 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007830 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00007831 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
7832 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007833 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
7834 }
7835
7836 if (!Indices.empty())
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00007837 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices, GEP.getName());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00007838
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007839 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00007840 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
7841 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
7842
7843 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00007844 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00007845 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
7846 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
7847 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
7848
7849 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00007850 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
7851 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00007852
7853 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
7854 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
7855 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007856 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00007857 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
7858 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
7859 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
7860 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
7861 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
7862 //
7863 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
7864 //
7865 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
7866 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
7867 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
7868 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
7869 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
7870 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
7871 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
7872 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
7873 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
7874 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
7875 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
7876 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
7877 return &GEP;
7878 }
7879 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
7880 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007881 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
7882 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00007883 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
7884 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
7885 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
7886 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
7887 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
7888 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007889 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00007890 GEP.getOperand(1), GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007891 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
7892 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007893 }
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007894
7895 // Transform things like:
7896 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
7897 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
7898 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
7899
7900 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007901 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007902 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
7903 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
7904
7905 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
7906 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
7907 Value *NewIdx = 0;
7908 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
7909 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
7910 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
7911 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
7912 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnera393e4d2005-09-14 17:32:56 +00007913 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007914 Scale = CI;
7915 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
7916 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
7917 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007918 unsigned ShAmt =
7919 cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007920 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmt);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007921 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
7922 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
7923 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
7924 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
7925 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
7926 }
7927 }
7928
7929 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
7930 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007931 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00007932 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007933 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
7934 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
7935 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007936 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
7937 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007938 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
7939 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
7940 }
7941
7942 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007943 Instruction *NewGEP =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007944 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007945 NewIdx, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007946 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
7947 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
7948 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00007949 }
7950 }
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007951 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007952 }
7953
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007954 return 0;
7955}
7956
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00007957Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
7958 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
7959 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007960 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
7961 const Type *NewTy =
7962 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00007963 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00007964
7965 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
7966 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00007967 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00007968 else {
7969 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00007970 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00007971 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00007972
7973 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007974
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00007975 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
7976 // allocas if possible...
7977 //
7978 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
7979 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
7980
7981 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
7982 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
7983 //
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007984 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00007985 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, NullIdx, NullIdx,
7986 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00007987
7988 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
7989 // allocation.
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00007990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007991 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
7992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00007993 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00007994
7995 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
7996 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
7997 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007998 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattner49df6ce2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00007999 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8001
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008002 return 0;
8003}
8004
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008005Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8006 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8007
8008 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8009 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op))
8010 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
8011 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8012 return &FI;
8013 }
8014
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008015 // free undef -> unreachable.
8016 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8017 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008018 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008019 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008020 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8021 }
8022
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008023 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8024 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008025 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008026 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008027
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008028 return 0;
8029}
8030
8031
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008032/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008033static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8034 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008035 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008036
8037 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008038 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008039 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008040
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008041 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
8042 isa<PackedType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008043 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8044 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8045 // constants.
8046 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8047 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8048 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008049 Value *Idxs[2];
8050 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8051 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008052 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8053 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8054 }
8055
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008056 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
8057 isa<PackedType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerecfa9b52005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008058 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8059 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8060 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008061 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8062 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008063
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008064 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8065 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8066 // the result of the loaded value.
8067 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8068 CI->getName(),
8069 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8070 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008071 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008072 }
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008073 }
8074 }
8075 return 0;
8076}
8077
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008078/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008079/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8080/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8081/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8082static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
8083 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
8084 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
8085
8086 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8087 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008088 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8089 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8090 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008091 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8092
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008093 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008094 --BBI;
8095
8096 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8097 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8098 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8099 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008100
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008101 }
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008102 return false;
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008103}
8104
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008105Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8106 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7e8af382004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008107
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008108 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008109 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008110 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8111 return Res;
8112
8113 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
8114 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008115
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008116 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
8117 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008118 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
8119 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008120 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8121 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
8122 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008123 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
8124 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
8125 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008126 }
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008127
8128 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
8129 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0)) ||
8130 isa<UndefValue>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
8131 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8132 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8133 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8134 // CFG.
8135 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8136 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8137 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8138 }
8139
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008140 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008141 // load null/undef -> undef
8142 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008143 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
8144 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
8145 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008146 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8147 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008148 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008149 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008150
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008151 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
8152 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008153 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008154 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008155
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008156 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
8157 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
8158 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
8159 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008160 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner0b011ec2005-09-26 05:28:06 +00008161 if (Constant *V =
8162 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008164 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
8165 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8166 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8167 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8168 // CFG.
8169 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8170 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8172 }
8173
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008174 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008175 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8176 return Res;
8177 }
8178 }
Chris Lattnere228ee52004-04-08 20:39:49 +00008179
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008180 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008181 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
8182 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
8183 // exposes redundancy in the code.
8184 //
8185 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
8186 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
8187 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
8188 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
8189 // unconditionally.
8190 //
8191 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
8192 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008193 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
8194 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008195 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008196 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008197 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008198 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008199 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
8200 }
8201
Chris Lattnerbdcf41a2004-09-23 15:46:00 +00008202 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
8203 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
8204 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8205 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
8206 return &LI;
8207 }
8208
8209 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
8210 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
8211 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8212 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
8213 return &LI;
8214 }
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008215 }
8216 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008217 return 0;
8218}
8219
Reid Spencere928a152007-01-19 21:20:31 +00008220/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008221/// when possible.
8222static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
8223 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
8224 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
8225
8226 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8227 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
8228 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8229
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008230 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008231 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8232 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8233 // constants.
8234 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8235 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8236 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008237 Value* Idxs[2];
8238 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8239 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008240 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8241 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8242 }
8243
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008244 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
8245 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8246 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008247
8248 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008249 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
8250 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008251 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008252 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008253 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
8254 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
8255 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
8256 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
8257 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008258 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008259 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008260 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008261 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
8262 }
8263 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008264 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008265 else
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008266 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008267 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
8268 SI);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008269 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
8270 }
8271 }
8272 }
8273 return 0;
8274}
8275
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008276Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
8277 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
8278 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
8279
8280 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008281 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008282 ++NumCombined;
8283 return 0;
8284 }
Chris Lattnera4beeef2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00008285
8286 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
8287 // alloca dead.
8288 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
8289 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
8290 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8291 ++NumCombined;
8292 return 0;
8293 }
8294
8295 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
8296 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
8297 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8298 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8299 ++NumCombined;
8300 return 0;
8301 }
8302 }
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008303
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008304 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
8305 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
8306 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
8307 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
8308 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
8309 --ScanInsts) {
8310 --BBI;
8311
8312 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
8313 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
8314 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8315 ++NumDeadStore;
8316 ++BBI;
8317 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
8318 continue;
8319 }
8320 break;
8321 }
8322
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008323 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
8324 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
8325 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
8326 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8327 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr) {
8328 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8329 ++NumCombined;
8330 return 0;
8331 }
8332 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
8333 // may not be dead.
8334 break;
8335 }
8336
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008337 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008338 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008339 break;
8340 }
8341
8342
8343 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008344
8345 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
8346 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
8347 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
8348 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
8349 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
8350 WorkList.push_back(U); // Dropped a use.
8351 ++NumCombined;
8352 }
8353 return 0; // Do not modify these!
8354 }
8355
8356 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
8357 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008358 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008359 ++NumCombined;
8360 return 0;
8361 }
8362
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008363 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
8364 // source instead.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008365 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008366 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8367 return Res;
8368 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008369 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008370 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8371 return Res;
8372
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008373
8374 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
8375 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008376 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008377 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
8378 if (BI->isUnconditional()) {
8379 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
8380 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
8381 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
8382 BasicBlock *Dest = BI->getSuccessor(0);
8383
8384 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(Dest);
8385 BasicBlock *Other = 0;
8386 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8387 Other = *PI;
8388 ++PI;
8389 if (PI != pred_end(Dest)) {
8390 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8391 if (Other)
8392 Other = 0;
8393 else
8394 Other = *PI;
8395 if (++PI != pred_end(Dest))
8396 Other = 0;
8397 }
8398 if (Other) { // If only one other pred...
8399 BBI = Other->getTerminator();
8400 // Make sure this other block ends in an unconditional branch and that
8401 // there is an instruction before the branch.
8402 if (isa<BranchInst>(BBI) && cast<BranchInst>(BBI)->isUnconditional() &&
8403 BBI != Other->begin()) {
8404 --BBI;
8405 StoreInst *OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
8406
8407 // If this instruction is a store to the same location.
8408 if (OtherStore && OtherStore->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8409 // Okay, we know we can perform this transformation. Insert a PHI
8410 // node now if we need it.
8411 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
8412 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
8413 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
8414 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
8415 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
8416 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), Other);
8417 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, Dest->front());
8418 }
8419
8420 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
8421 // insert it.
8422 BBI = Dest->begin();
8423 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
8424 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
8425 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
8426
8427 // Nuke the old stores.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008428 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8429 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008430 ++NumCombined;
8431 return 0;
8432 }
8433 }
8434 }
8435 }
8436
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008437 return 0;
8438}
8439
8440
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008441Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
8442 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00008443 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008444 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
8445 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
8446 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
8447 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
8448 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8449 BI.setCondition(X);
8450 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8451 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
8452 return &BI;
8453 }
8454
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008455 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
8456 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
8457 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8458 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8459 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
8460 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8461 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008462 std::string Name = I->getName(); I->setName("");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008463 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
8464 Value *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, Name, I);
8465 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8466 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
8467 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8468 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
8469 removeFromWorkList(I);
8470 I->getParent()->getInstList().erase(I);
8471 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(NewSCC));
8472 return &BI;
8473 }
8474
8475 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
8476 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
8477 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8478 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8479 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
8480 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
8481 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8482 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
8483 std::string Name = I->getName(); I->setName("");
8484 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
8485 Value *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, Name, I);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008486 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008487 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008488 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8489 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008490 removeFromWorkList(I);
8491 I->getParent()->getInstList().erase(I);
8492 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(NewSCC));
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008493 return &BI;
8494 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008495
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008496 return 0;
8497}
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008498
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008499Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
8500 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
8501 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
8502 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
8503 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
8504 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
8505 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008506 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008507 AddRHS));
8508 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
8509 WorkList.push_back(I);
8510 return &SI;
8511 }
8512 }
8513 return 0;
8514}
8515
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008516/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
8517/// is to leave as a vector operation.
8518static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
8519 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8520 return true;
8521 if (ConstantPacked *C = dyn_cast<ConstantPacked>(V)) {
8522 if (isConstant) return true;
8523 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
8524 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
8525 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
8526 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
8527 return false;
8528 return true;
8529 }
8530 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
8531 if (!I) return false;
8532
8533 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
8534 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
8535 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
8536 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
8537 return true;
8538 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
8539 return true;
8540 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
8541 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
8542 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8543 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8544 return true;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008545 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
8546 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
8547 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8548 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8549 return true;
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008550
8551 return false;
8552}
8553
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008554/// getShuffleMask - Read and decode a shufflevector mask. It turns undef
8555/// elements into values that are larger than the #elts in the input.
8556static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
8557 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
8558 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8559 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
8560 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8561 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
8562
8563 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
8564 const ConstantPacked *CP = cast<ConstantPacked>(SVI->getOperand(2));
8565 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
8566 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
8567 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
8568 else
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008569 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008570 return Result;
8571}
8572
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008573/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
8574/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
8575/// extracted from the vector.
8576static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
8577 assert(isa<PackedType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
8578 const PackedType *PTy = cast<PackedType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008579 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
8580 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008581 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8582
8583 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
8584 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8585 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8586 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
8587 else if (ConstantPacked *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantPacked>(V))
8588 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
8589 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8590 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008591 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
8592 return 0;
8593 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008594
8595 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
8596 // inserted value.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008597 if (EltNo == IIElt)
8598 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008599
8600 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
8601 // vector input.
8602 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008603 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008604 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
8605 if (InEl < Width)
8606 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
8607 else if (InEl < Width*2)
8608 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
8609 else
8610 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008611 }
8612
8613 // Otherwise, we don't know.
8614 return 0;
8615}
8616
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008617Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008618
Chris Lattner92346c32006-03-31 18:25:14 +00008619 // If packed val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
8620 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8621 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
8622
8623 // If packed val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
8624 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8625 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
8626
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008627 if (ConstantPacked *C = dyn_cast<ConstantPacked>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
8628 // If packed val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
8629 // with that operand
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008630 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008631 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008632 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
8633 op0 = 0;
8634 break;
8635 }
8636 if (op0)
8637 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008638 }
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008639
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008640 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
8641 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008642 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008643 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
8644 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
8645 // property.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008646 uint64_t IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008647 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8648 uint64_t UndefElts;
8649 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008650 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008651 UndefElts)) {
8652 EI.setOperand(0, V);
8653 return &EI;
8654 }
8655 }
8656
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008657 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008659 }
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008660
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008661 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008662 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
8663 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
8664 // profitable to do so
8665 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008666 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
8667 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
8668 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
8669 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
8670 EI.getName()+".lhs");
8671 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
8672 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
8673 EI.getName()+".rhs");
8674 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
8675 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
8676 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
8677 }
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008678 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008679 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008680 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
8681 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencera736fdf2006-11-29 01:11:01 +00008682 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008683 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
8684 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008685 }
8686 }
8687 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
8688 // Extracting the inserted element?
8689 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
8690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
8691 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
8692 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
8693 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
8694 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
8695 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
8696 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
8697 return &EI;
8698 }
8699 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
8700 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
8701 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008702 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
8703 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008704 Value *Src;
8705 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
8706 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
8707 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
8708 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
8709 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
8710 } else {
8711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner612fa8e2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00008712 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008713 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008714 }
8715 }
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008716 }
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008717 return 0;
8718}
8719
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008720/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
8721/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
8722/// Otherwise, return false.
8723static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
8724 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
8725 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
8726 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
8727 unsigned NumElts = cast<PackedType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
8728
8729 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008730 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008731 return true;
8732 } else if (V == LHS) {
8733 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008734 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008735 return true;
8736 } else if (V == RHS) {
8737 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008738 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008739 return true;
8740 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8741 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
8742 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
8743 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
8744 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
8745
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008746 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
8747 return false;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008748 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008749
8750 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
8751 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
8752 // transitively ok.
8753 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
8754 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008755 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008756 return true;
8757 }
8758 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
8759 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008760 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
8761 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008762 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008763
8764 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
8765 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
8766 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
8767 // transitively ok.
8768 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
8769 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
8770 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
8771 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008772 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008773 } else {
8774 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
8775 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008776 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008777
8778 }
8779 return true;
8780 }
8781 }
8782 }
8783 }
8784 }
8785 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
8786
8787 return false;
8788}
8789
8790/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
8791/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
8792/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008793static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008794 Value *&RHS) {
8795 assert(isa<PackedType>(V->getType()) &&
8796 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008797 "Invalid shuffle!");
8798 unsigned NumElts = cast<PackedType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
8799
8800 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008801 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008802 return V;
8803 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008804 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008805 return V;
8806 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8807 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
8808 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
8809 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
8810 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
8811
8812 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
8813 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
8814 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
8815 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008816 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
8817 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008818
8819 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
8820 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008821 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
8822 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
8823 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008824 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008825 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008826 return V;
8827 }
8828
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008829 if (VecOp == RHS) {
8830 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008831 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
8832 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
8833 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008834 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008835 }
8836 return V;
8837 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008838
8839 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
8840 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
8841 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
8842 return EI->getOperand(0);
8843
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008844 }
8845 }
8846 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008847 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008848
8849 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
8850 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008851 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008852 return V;
8853}
8854
8855Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
8856 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
8857 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
8858 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
8859
8860 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
8861 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
8862 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
8863 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
8864 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
8865 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008866 unsigned ExtractedIdx=cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
8867 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008868
8869 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
8870 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
8871
8872 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
8873 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
8874
8875 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
8876 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
8877 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
8878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
8879
8880 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
8881 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
8882 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
8883 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
8884 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
8885 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
8886 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
8887 // Build a new shuffle mask.
8888 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
8889 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008890 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008891 else {
8892 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008893 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008894 NumVectorElts));
8895 }
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008896 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008897 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
8898 ConstantPacked::get(Mask));
8899 }
8900
8901 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
8902 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
8903 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
8904 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008905 Value *RHS = 0;
8906 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
8907 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
8908 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
8909 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantPacked::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008910 }
8911 }
8912 }
8913
8914 return 0;
8915}
8916
8917
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008918Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
8919 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
8920 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008921 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008922
8923 bool MadeChange = false;
8924
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008925 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008926 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
8928
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00008929 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008930 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00008931 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
8932 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
8933 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
8934 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
8935 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
8936 Mask[i] = 2*e;
8937 MadeChange = true;
8938 }
8939 }
8940
8941 if (MadeChange) {
8942 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
8943 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
8944 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
8945 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
8946 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
8947 else
8948 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
8949 }
8950 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantPacked::get(Elts));
8951 }
8952 }
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00008953
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008954 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
8955 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
8956 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
8957 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008958 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
8959 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
8960 }
8961
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008962 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
8963 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
8964 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00008965 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008966 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00008967 else {
8968 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
8969 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
8970 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
8971 else
8972 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008973 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00008974 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008975 }
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008976 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008977 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008978 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantPacked::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00008979 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
8980 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008981 MadeChange = true;
8982 }
8983
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00008984 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008985 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00008986
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008987 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
8988 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
8989 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
8990 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
8991
8992 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
8993 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00008994 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008995
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008996 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
8997 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
8998 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00008999
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009000 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9001 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9002 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9003 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9004 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9005 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9006 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9007 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9008 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9009 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9010 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9011 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9012
9013 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9014 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9015 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9016 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9017 else
9018 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
9019
9020 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
9021 // the replacement.
9022 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
9023 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9024 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9025 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009026 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009027 } else {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009028 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009029 }
9030 }
9031 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
9032 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
9033 ConstantPacked::get(Elts));
9034 }
9035 }
9036 }
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00009037
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009038 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
9039}
9040
9041
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009042
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009043void InstCombiner::removeFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
9044 WorkList.erase(std::remove(WorkList.begin(), WorkList.end(), I),
9045 WorkList.end());
9046}
9047
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009048
9049/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
9050/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
9051/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
9052/// end of its block.
9053static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
9054 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
9055
Chris Lattnerc4f67e62005-10-27 17:13:11 +00009056 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
9057 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009058
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009059 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
9060 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() == &DestBlock->getParent()->front())
9061 return false;
9062
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009063 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
9064 // the end of block that could change the value.
9065 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009066 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
9067 Scan != E; ++Scan)
9068 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
9069 return false;
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009070 }
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009071
9072 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
9073 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
9074
Chris Lattner9f269e42005-08-08 19:11:57 +00009075 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009076 ++NumSunkInst;
9077 return true;
9078}
9079
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009080
9081/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
9082/// all reachable code to the worklist.
9083///
9084/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
9085/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
9086/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
9087/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
9088/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
9089///
9090static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
9091 std::set<BasicBlock*> &Visited,
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009092 std::vector<Instruction*> &WorkList,
9093 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009094 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, bail out.
9095 if (!Visited.insert(BB).second) return;
9096
9097 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
9098 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
9099
9100 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
9101 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
9102 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009103 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009104 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9105 continue;
9106 }
9107
9108 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
Chris Lattnere3eda252007-01-30 23:16:15 +00009109 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009110 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009111 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
9112 ++NumConstProp;
9113 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9114 continue;
9115 }
9116
9117 WorkList.push_back(Inst);
9118 }
9119
9120 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a constant,
9121 // only visit the reachable successor.
9122 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
9123 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009124 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009125 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009126 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal), Visited, WorkList,
9127 TD);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009128 return;
9129 }
9130 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
9131 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
9132 // See if this is an explicit destination.
9133 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9134 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009135 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(SI->getSuccessor(i), Visited, WorkList,TD);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009136 return;
9137 }
9138
9139 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009140 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(SI->getSuccessor(0), Visited, WorkList, TD);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009141 return;
9142 }
9143 }
9144
9145 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009146 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(TI->getSuccessor(i), Visited, WorkList, TD);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009147}
9148
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009149bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009150 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00009151 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009152
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009153 {
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009154 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
9155 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
9156 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009157 std::set<BasicBlock*> Visited;
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009158 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, WorkList, TD);
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00009159
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009160 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
9161 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
9162 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
9163 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
9164 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
9165 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
9166 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
9167 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner2d3a7a62004-04-27 15:13:33 +00009168
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009169 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009170 ++NumDeadInst;
9171
9172 if (!I->use_empty())
9173 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
9174 I->eraseFromParent();
9175 }
9176 }
9177 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009178
9179 while (!WorkList.empty()) {
9180 Instruction *I = WorkList.back(); // Get an instruction from the worklist
9181 WorkList.pop_back();
9182
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009183 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009184 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009185 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009186 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009187 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009188 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009189
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009190 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009191
9192 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009193 removeFromWorkList(I);
9194 continue;
9195 }
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009196
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009197 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattnere3eda252007-01-30 23:16:15 +00009198 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009199 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009200
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009201 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009202 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc6509f42002-12-05 22:41:53 +00009203 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
9204
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009205 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009206 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner800aaaf2003-10-07 15:17:02 +00009207 removeFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009208 continue;
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009209 }
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009210
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009211 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
9212 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9213 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
9214 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
9215 if (UserParent != BB) {
9216 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
9217 // See if the user is one of our successors.
9218 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
9219 if (*SI == UserParent) {
9220 UserIsSuccessor = true;
9221 break;
9222 }
9223
9224 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
9225 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
9226 // otherwise), we can keep going.
9227 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
9228 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
9229 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
9230 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
9231 }
9232 }
9233
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009234 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009235 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner0b18c1d2002-05-10 15:38:35 +00009236 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009237 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009238 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009239 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
9240 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009241
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009242 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
9243 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
9244
9245 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
9246 WorkList.push_back(Result);
9247 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009248
9249 // Move the name to the new instruction first...
9250 std::string OldName = I->getName(); I->setName("");
Chris Lattner950fc782003-10-07 22:58:41 +00009251 Result->setName(OldName);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009252
9253 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
9254 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009255 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
9256
9257 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
9258 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
9259 ++InsertPos;
9260
9261 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009262
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009263 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
9264 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerb643a9e2004-05-01 23:19:52 +00009265 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9266 if (Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(i)))
9267 WorkList.push_back(OpI);
9268
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009269 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
9270 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
9271 removeFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009272
9273 // Erase the old instruction.
9274 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009275 } else {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009276 DOUT << "IC: MOD = " << *I;
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009277
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009278 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
9279 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009280 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
9281 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
9282 // use counts.
9283 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9284 if (Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(i)))
9285 WorkList.push_back(OpI);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009286
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009287 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009288 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009289 removeFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009290 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009291 } else {
9292 WorkList.push_back(Result);
9293 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009294 }
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009295 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009296 Changed = true;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009297 }
9298 }
9299
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009300 return Changed;
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009301}
9302
Brian Gaeke38b79e82004-07-27 17:43:21 +00009303FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009304 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009305}
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +00009306